blob: 84a3f9a4836f49b58f3ee7141a80124a1ac86efa [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100458 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200460 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200461 - noepoll
462 - nokqueue
463 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100468 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200469 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100470 - tune.maxaccept
471 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200472 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200473 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100474 - tune.rcvbuf.client
475 - tune.rcvbuf.server
476 - tune.sndbuf.client
477 - tune.sndbuf.server
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100478 - tune.zlib.memlevel
479 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481 * Debugging
482 - debug
483 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484
485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004863.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487------------------------------------
488
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200489ca-base <dir>
490 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200491 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
492 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494chroot <jail dir>
495 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
496 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
497 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
498 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
499 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
500 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100502cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
503 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
504 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
505 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
506 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
507 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
508 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
509 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
510 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
511 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
512 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
513 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
514 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
515 they overlap.
516
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517crt-base <dir>
518 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
519 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
520 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
521
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522daemon
523 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
524 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
525 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
526
527gid <number>
528 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
529 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
530 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
531 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100532
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533group <group name>
534 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
535 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100536
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200537log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
539 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100540 configured with "log global".
541
542 <address> can be one of:
543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100544 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100545 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
546 port).
547
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100548 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
549 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
550 port).
551
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100552 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
553 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
554 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
555 writeable).
556
557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558
559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
562
563 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200564 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
565 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
566 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
567 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
568 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
569 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200571 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100573log-send-hostname [<string>]
574 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
575 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
576 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
577 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
578 the logs.
579
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000580log-tag <string>
581 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
582 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
583 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
584 running on the same host.
585
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586nbproc <number>
587 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
588 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
589 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
590 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
591 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
592
593pidfile <pidfile>
594 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
595 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
596 starting the process. See also "daemon".
597
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100598stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200599 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
600 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
601 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
602 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
603 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
604 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
605 the number of processes used.
606
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200607stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
608 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
609 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
610 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
611 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200612
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200613 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
614 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
615 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200616
617stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
618 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
619 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100620 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621
622stats maxconn <connections>
623 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
624 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626uid <number>
627 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
628 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
629 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
630 one. See also "gid" and "user".
631
632ulimit-n <number>
633 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
634 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
635 option.
636
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100637unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
638 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
639
640 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
641 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
642 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
643 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
644 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
645 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
646 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
647 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
648 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
649 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651user <user name>
652 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
653 See also "uid" and "group".
654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200655node <name>
656 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
657
658 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
659 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
660 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
661 traffic.
662
663description <text>
664 Add a text that describes the instance.
665
666 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
667 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
668 "<" and ">" characters.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672-----------------------
673
674maxconn <number>
675 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
676 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
677 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
678 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
679
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200680maxconnrate <number>
681 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
682 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
683 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
684 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
685 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
686 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
687 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
688 fairness.
689
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100690maxcomprate <number>
691 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
692 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
693 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
694 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
695 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
696 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
697 default value.
698
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100699maxpipes <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
701 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
702 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
703 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
704 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
705 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
706
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200707maxsslconn <number>
708 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
709 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
710 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
711 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
712 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
713 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
714 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
715
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100716maxzlibmem <number>
717 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
718 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
719 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
720 The default value is 0.
721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722noepoll
723 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
724 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100725 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726
727nokqueue
728 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
729 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
730 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
731
732nopoll
733 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
734 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100735 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100736 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100738nosplice
739 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
740 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
741 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100742 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100743 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
744 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
745 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
746 "option splice-response".
747
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200748spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
749 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
750 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
751 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
752 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
753 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
754
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200755tune.bufsize <number>
756 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
757 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
758 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
759 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
760 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
761 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
762 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
763 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400764 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
765 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
766 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200767
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200768tune.chksize <number>
769 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
770 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
771 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
772 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
773 checks whenever possible.
774
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100775tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
776 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
777 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
778 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
779 this value. The default value is 1.
780
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200781tune.http.maxhdr <number>
782 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
783 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
784 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
785 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
786 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
787 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
788 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
789 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
790 limit too high.
791
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100792tune.maxaccept <number>
793 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
794 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
795 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100796 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100797 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
798 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100799 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100800 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
801
802tune.maxpollevents <number>
803 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
804 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
805 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
806 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
807 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
808
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200809tune.maxrewrite <number>
810 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
811 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
812 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
813 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
814 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
815 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
816 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
817 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
818 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
819 bufsize.
820
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200821tune.pipesize <number>
822 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
823 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
824 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
825 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
826 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
827 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
828
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100829tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
830tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
831 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
832 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
833 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
834 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
835 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
836 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
837 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
838
839tune.sndbuf.client <number>
840tune.sndbuf.server <number>
841 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
842 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
843 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
844 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
845 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
846 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
847 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
848 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
849 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
850 notifying haproxy again.
851
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100852tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
853 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
854 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
855 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
856 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
857 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
858
859tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
860 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
861 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
862 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
863 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008653.3. Debugging
866--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200867
868debug
869 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
870 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
871 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
872 system startup.
873
874quiet
875 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
876 line argument "-q".
877
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008793.4. Userlists
880--------------
881It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
882http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
883it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
884
885userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100886 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100887 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
888
889group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100890 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100891 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
892 proceeded by "users" keyword.
893
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100894user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
895 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100896 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
897 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100898 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
899 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100900 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
901 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
902
903
904 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100905 userlist L1
906 group G1 users tiger,scott
907 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100908
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100909 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
910 user scott insecure-password elgato
911 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100912
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100913 userlist L2
914 group G1
915 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100916
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100917 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
918 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
919 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100920
921 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200923
9243.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200925----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200926It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
927haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
928pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
929identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
930or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
931Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
932known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
933the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
934process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
935during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
936tables.
937
938peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400939 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200940 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
941
942peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
943 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
944 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
945 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
946 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
947 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
948 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
949
950 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
951 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
952
953 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
954 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
955 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
956 across all peers.
957
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200958 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200959 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100960 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
961 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
962 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200963
964 backend mybackend
965 mode tcp
966 balance roundrobin
967 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
968 stick on src
969
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100970 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
971 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200972
973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009744. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
978 - defaults <name>
979 - frontend <name>
980 - backend <name>
981 - listen <name>
982
983A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
984its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
985section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100986section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
988A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
989connections.
990
991A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
992to forward incoming connections.
993
994A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
995parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100997All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
998'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
999case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1000
1001Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1002logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1003proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1004However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1005name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1006
1007Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1008and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001009bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001010protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1011modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1012arbitrary criteria.
1013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010154.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1016--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1019limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1020they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1021limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001023option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001024and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1025with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1026specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001029 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1030------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1031acl - X X X
1032appsession - - X X
1033backlog X X X -
1034balance X - X X
1035bind - X X -
1036bind-process X X X X
1037block - X X X
1038capture cookie - X X -
1039capture request header - X X -
1040capture response header - X X -
1041clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001042compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001043contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1044cookie X - X X
1045default-server X - X X
1046default_backend X X X -
1047description - X X X
1048disabled X X X X
1049dispatch - - X X
1050enabled X X X X
1051errorfile X X X X
1052errorloc X X X X
1053errorloc302 X X X X
1054-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1055errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001056force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001057fullconn X - X X
1058grace X X X X
1059hash-type X - X X
1060http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001061http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001062http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001063http-request - X X X
1064id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001065ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001066log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001067maxconn X X X -
1068mode X X X X
1069monitor fail - X X -
1070monitor-net X X X -
1071monitor-uri X X X -
1072option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1073option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1074option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1075option allbackups (*) X - X X
1076option checkcache (*) X - X X
1077option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1078option contstats (*) X X X -
1079option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1080option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1081option forceclose (*) X X X X
1082-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1083option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001084option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001085option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1087option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1088option httpchk X - X X
1089option httpclose (*) X X X X
1090option httplog X X X X
1091option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001092option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001093option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001094option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1095option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1096option logasap (*) X X X -
1097option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001098option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001099option nolinger (*) X X X X
1100option originalto X X X X
1101option persist (*) X - X X
1102option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001103option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001104option smtpchk X - X X
1105option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1106option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1107option splice-request (*) X X X X
1108option splice-response (*) X X X X
1109option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1110option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1111-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1112option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1113option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1114option tcpka X X X X
1115option tcplog X X X X
1116option transparent (*) X - X X
1117persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1118rate-limit sessions X X X -
1119redirect - X X X
1120redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1121redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1122reqadd - X X X
1123reqallow - X X X
1124reqdel - X X X
1125reqdeny - X X X
1126reqiallow - X X X
1127reqidel - X X X
1128reqideny - X X X
1129reqipass - X X X
1130reqirep - X X X
1131reqisetbe - X X X
1132reqitarpit - X X X
1133reqpass - X X X
1134reqrep - X X X
1135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1136reqsetbe - X X X
1137reqtarpit - X X X
1138retries X - X X
1139rspadd - X X X
1140rspdel - X X X
1141rspdeny - X X X
1142rspidel - X X X
1143rspideny - X X X
1144rspirep - X X X
1145rsprep - X X X
1146server - - X X
1147source X - X X
1148srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001149stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001150stats auth X - X X
1151stats enable X - X X
1152stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001153stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001154stats realm X - X X
1155stats refresh X - X X
1156stats scope X - X X
1157stats show-desc X - X X
1158stats show-legends X - X X
1159stats show-node X - X X
1160stats uri X - X X
1161-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1162stick match - - X X
1163stick on - - X X
1164stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001165stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001166stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001167tcp-request connection - X X -
1168tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001169tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001170tcp-response content - - X X
1171tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001172timeout check X - X X
1173timeout client X X X -
1174timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1175timeout connect X - X X
1176timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1177timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1178timeout http-request X X X X
1179timeout queue X - X X
1180timeout server X - X X
1181timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1182timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001183timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001184transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001185unique-id-format X X X -
1186unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001188use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001189------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1190 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1194---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195
1196This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1197
1198
1199acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1200 Declare or complete an access list.
1201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1202 no | yes | yes | yes
1203 Example:
1204 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1205 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1206 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001208 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209
1210
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001211appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1212 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001213 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1215 no | no | yes | yes
1216 Arguments :
1217 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1218 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1219
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001220 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001221 checked in each cookie value.
1222
1223 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1224 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1225 milliseconds.
1226
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001227 request-learn
1228 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1229 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1230 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1231 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1232 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1233 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1234
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001235 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1236 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1237 data following this prefix.
1238
1239 Example :
1240 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1241
1242 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1243 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1244
1245 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1246 2 modes are currently supported :
1247 - path-parameters :
1248 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1249 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1250 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1251 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1252 - query-string :
1253 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1254 query string.
1255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001256 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1257 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1258 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1259 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001260 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1261 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1262 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001263 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1264 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1265
1266 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1267
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001268 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1269 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1270 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272 Example :
1273 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1274
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001275 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1276 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001277
1278
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001279backlog <conns>
1280 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1282 yes | yes | yes | no
1283 Arguments :
1284 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1285 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001286 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001287
1288 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1289 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1290 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1291 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1292 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1293 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1294 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1295 backlog parameter.
1296
1297 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1298 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1299 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1300
1301 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1302
1303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001304balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001305balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001306 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1308 yes | no | yes | yes
1309 Arguments :
1310 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1311 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1312 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1313 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1314
1315 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1316 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1317 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1318 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001319 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1320 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1321 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1322 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1323 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1324 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1325 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1326 it, so that you don't worry.
1327
1328 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1329 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1330 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1331 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1332 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1333 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1334 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1335 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001336
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001337 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1338 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1339 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1340 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1341 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1342 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1343 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1344 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1345
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001346 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1347 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1348 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1349 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001350 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001351 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1352 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1353 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1354 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1355 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001356 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1357 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1358 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1359 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1360 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1361 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001363 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1364 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1365 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1366 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1367 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1368 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1369 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1370 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001371 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001372 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001373 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1374 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1375 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001376
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001377 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1378 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1379 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1380 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1381 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1382 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1383 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1384 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1385 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1386 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1387 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1388 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001390 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001391 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1392 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1393 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1394 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1395 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1396 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1397 URIs start with a leading "/".
1398
1399 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1400 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1401 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1402 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001405 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1406
1407 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001408 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1409 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1410 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1411 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1412 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1413 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1414 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1415 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1416 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1417 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1418 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1419 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1420 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1421 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1422 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1423 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1424 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1425 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1426 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001427
1428 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1429 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1430 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1431 server will receive the request.
1432
1433 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1434 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1435 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1436 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1437 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001438 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1439 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1440 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001442 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1443 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1444 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1445 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1446 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001448 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001449 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1450 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1451 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1452
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001453 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1454 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1455 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1456
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001457 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001458 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001459 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1460 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1461 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1462 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1463 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1464 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001465 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001466 used instead.
1467
1468 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1469 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1470 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1471 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1472
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001473 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1474 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1475 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1476
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001477 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001480 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1481 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001482
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001483 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001484 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001486 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1487 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1488 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001489
1490 Examples :
1491 balance roundrobin
1492 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001493 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001494 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1495 balance hdr(host)
1496 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001497
1498 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1499 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001501 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001502 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1503 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1504 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1505 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1506
1507 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1508 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1509 defaults to 16 kB.
1510
1511 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1512 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1513
1514 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1515 Round Robin.
1516
1517 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1518 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1519 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1520 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1521
1522 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1523
1524 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001525 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001526 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1527 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1528 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001530 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1531 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532
1533
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001534bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1535bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1538 no | yes | yes | no
1539 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001540 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1541 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1542 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1543 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001544 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001545
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001546 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1547 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001548 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1549 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1550 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001551 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1552 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1553 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1554 the range.
1555
1556 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1557 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1558 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1559 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1560 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1561 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1562 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001563 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001564 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001566 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1567 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1568 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1569 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1570 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1571 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1572 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1573 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001575 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1576 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1577 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1578 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1581 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1582 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1583 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1584 in a frontend.
1585
1586 Example :
1587 listen http_proxy
1588 bind :80,:443
1589 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001590 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001592 listen http_https_proxy
1593 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001594 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001595
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001596 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001597 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001598
1599
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001600bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001601 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1603 yes | yes | yes | yes
1604 Arguments :
1605 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1606 may be used to override a default value.
1607
1608 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1609 option may be combined with other numbers.
1610
1611 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1612 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1613 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1614 missing from all processes.
1615
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001616 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1617 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1618 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1619 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1620 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001621
1622 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1623 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1624 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1625 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1626 and 'even' instances.
1627
1628 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1629 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1630 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1631 32.
1632
1633 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1634 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1635
1636 Example :
1637 listen app_ip1
1638 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001639 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001640
1641 listen app_ip2
1642 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001643 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001644
1645 listen management
1646 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001647 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001648
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001649 listen management
1650 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1651 bind-process 1-4
1652
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001653 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1654
1655
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656block { if | unless } <condition>
1657 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1659 no | yes | yes | yes
1660
1661 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1662 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001663 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001664 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001665 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1666 "block" statements per instance.
1667
1668 Example:
1669 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1670 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1671 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1672 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001674 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001675
1676
1677capture cookie <name> len <length>
1678 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1680 no | yes | yes | no
1681 Arguments :
1682 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1683 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1684 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1685 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1686 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1687
1688 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1689 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1690 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1691 right if it exceeds <length>.
1692
1693 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1694 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1695 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1696 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1697
1698 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1699 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1700 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1701
1702 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1703 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1704 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1705 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001706 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1708
1709 Example:
1710 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1711
1712 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001713 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001714
1715
1716capture request header <name> len <length>
1717 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1719 no | yes | yes | no
1720 Arguments :
1721 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001722 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1724 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1725 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1726
1727 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1728 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1729 it exceeds <length>.
1730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001731 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001732 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1733 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001734 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1735 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1736 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1737 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001738 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001739 environments to find where the request came from.
1740
1741 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1742 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1743 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1744 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
1746 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1747 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1748 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1749 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1750
1751 Example:
1752 capture request header Host len 15
1753 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1754 capture request header Referrer len 15
1755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001756 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 about logging.
1758
1759
1760capture response header <name> len <length>
1761 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1763 no | yes | yes | no
1764 Arguments :
1765 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001766 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1768 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1769 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1770
1771 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1772 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1773 it exceeds <length>.
1774
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001775 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1777 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1778 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001779 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1780 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1781 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1782 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783
1784 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1785 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1786 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1787 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1788
1789 Example:
1790 capture response header Content-length len 9
1791 capture response header Location len 15
1792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001793 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794 about logging.
1795
1796
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001797clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1800 yes | yes | yes | no
1801 Arguments :
1802 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1804 as explained at the top of this document.
1805
1806 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1807 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1808 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1809 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1810 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1811 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1812 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1813 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001814 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001815 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1816 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1817
1818 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1819 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1820 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1821 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1822 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1823 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1824
1825 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1826 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1827
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001828 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1829 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001831compression algo <algorithm> ...
1832compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001833compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001834 Enable HTTP compression.
1835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1836 yes | yes | yes | yes
1837 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001838 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1839 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1840 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1841
1842 The currently supported algorithms are :
1843 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developping
1844 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1845 data.
1846
1847 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1848 support for zlib was built in.
1849
1850 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1851 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1852 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1853 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1854 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1855 in.
1856
1857 Compression will be activated depending of the Accept-Encoding request
1858 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001859
1860 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1861 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1862 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1863 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1864 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1865 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1866 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1867 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1868 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001869
1870 Examples :
1871 compression algo gzip
1872 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001874contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001875 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1877 yes | no | yes | yes
1878 Arguments :
1879 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1880 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1881 as explained at the top of this document.
1882
1883 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001884 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001885 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001886 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1887 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1888 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1889 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1890
1891 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1892 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1893 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1894 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1895 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1896 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1897
1898 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1899 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1900 instead.
1901
1902 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1903 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1904
1905
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001906cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001907 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1908 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001909 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1911 yes | no | yes | yes
1912 Arguments :
1913 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1914 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1915 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1916 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1917 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1918 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1919 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1920 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1921 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1922
1923 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1924 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1925 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1926 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1927 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1928 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1929 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1930 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1931 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1932 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1933 "insert" and "prefix".
1934
1935 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001936 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001937
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001938 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001939 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1940 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1941 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1942 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1943 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1944 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1945 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1946 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1947 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1948 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949
1950 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1951 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1952 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1953 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1954 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1955 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1956 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1957 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1958 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1959 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001960 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1961 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1962 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001963
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001964 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1965 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1966 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001967 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1968 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1969 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1970 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001971 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1972 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1973 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974
1975 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1976 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1977 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1978 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1979 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1980 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1981 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1982 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1983 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1984
1985 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1986 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1987 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1988 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1989 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1990 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1991 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1992 persistence cookie in the cache.
1993 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1994
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001995 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1996 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1997 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1998 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1999 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2000 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2001 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2002 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2003 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2004 they logout.
2005
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002006 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2007 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2008 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2009 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2010
2011 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2012 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2013 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2014 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2015 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2016 this attribute.
2017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002018 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002019 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002020 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2021 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2022 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2023 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2024 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2025 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002026
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002027 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2028 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2029 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2030 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2031 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2032 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2033 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2034 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2035 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2036 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2037 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2038 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2039 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2040 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2041 the site.
2042
2043 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2044 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2045 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2046 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2047 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2048 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2049 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2050 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2051 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2052 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2053 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2054 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2055 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2056 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2057 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2058 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2061 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2062 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2063 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 Examples :
2066 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2067 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2068 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002069 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002071 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002072 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002073
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002075default-server [param*]
2076 Change default options for a server in a backend
2077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2078 yes | no | yes | yes
2079 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002080 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2081 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2082 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2083 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002084
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002085 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002086 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2087
2088 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091default_backend <backend>
2092 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2094 yes | yes | yes | no
2095 Arguments :
2096 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2097
2098 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2099 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2100 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2101 will catch all undetermined requests.
2102
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103 Example :
2104
2105 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2106 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2107 default_backend dynamic
2108
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002109 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111
2112disabled
2113 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2115 yes | yes | yes | yes
2116 Arguments : none
2117
2118 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2119 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2120 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2121 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2122 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2123 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2124 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2125
2126 See also : "enabled"
2127
2128
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002129dispatch <address>:<port>
2130 Set a default server address
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002133 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002134
2135 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2136 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2137 during start-up.
2138
2139 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2140 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2141 possible with normal servers.
2142
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002143 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002144 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2145 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2146 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2147 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2148
2149 See also : "server"
2150
2151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152enabled
2153 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2155 yes | yes | yes | yes
2156 Arguments : none
2157
2158 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2159 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2160
2161 See also : "disabled"
2162
2163
2164errorfile <code> <file>
2165 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2167 yes | yes | yes | yes
2168 Arguments :
2169 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002170 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171
2172 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002173 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002175 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2176 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177
2178 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2179 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2180 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2181
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002182 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002184 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2185 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2186 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2187 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2188
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002189 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2190 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2191 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2192 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2193 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2194 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002196 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2197 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2198 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002199 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2201
2202 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2203
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002204 Example :
2205 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2206 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2207 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2208
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002209
2210errorloc <code> <url>
2211errorloc302 <code> <url>
2212 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2214 yes | yes | yes | yes
2215 Arguments :
2216 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002217 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218
2219 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2220 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2221 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2222 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2223 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2224
2225 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2226 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2227 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2228
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002229 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002231 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2232 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2233 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2234 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2235 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2236 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2237 request.
2238
2239 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2240
2241
2242errorloc303 <code> <url>
2243 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2245 yes | yes | yes | yes
2246 Arguments :
2247 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2248 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2249
2250 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2251 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2252 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2253 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2254 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2255
2256 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2257 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2258 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2259
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002260 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002262 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2263 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2264 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2265 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002266 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002267
2268 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2269
2270
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002271force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2272 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2274 no | yes | yes | yes
2275
2276 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2277 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2278 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2279 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2280 marked down for maintenance operations.
2281
2282 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2283 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2284 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2285 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2286 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2287 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2288 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2289 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2290 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2291
2292 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2293 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2294 is used.
2295
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002296 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002297 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002298
2299
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002300fullconn <conns>
2301 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2303 yes | no | yes | yes
2304 Arguments :
2305 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2306 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2307
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002308 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002309 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002310 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002311 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2312 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2313 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2314 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2315 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002317
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002318 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2319 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2320 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2321
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002322 Example :
2323 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2324 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2325 # connections.
2326 backend dynamic
2327 fullconn 10000
2328 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2329 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2330
2331 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2332
2333
2334grace <time>
2335 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002337 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002338 Arguments :
2339 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2340 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2341 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2342
2343 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2344 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002345 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002346 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2347
2348 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2349 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2350 simplify it.
2351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002353hash-type <method>
2354 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2356 yes | no | yes | yes
2357 Arguments :
2358 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2359 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2360 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2361 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2362 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2363 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2364 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2365 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2366 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2367
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002368 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2369 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2370 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2371 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2372 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2373 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2374 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2375 this value.
2376
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002377 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2378 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2379 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2380 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2381 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2382 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2383 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2384 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2385 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2386 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2387 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2388 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2389 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2390
2391 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2392
2393 See also : "balance", "server"
2394
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396http-check disable-on-404
2397 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002399 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400 Arguments : none
2401
2402 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2403 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2404 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2405 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2406 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2407 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2408 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2409 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002410 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2411 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2412 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2413
2414 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2415
2416
2417http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002418 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002421 Arguments :
2422 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2423 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002424 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002425 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2426 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2427 details on the supported keywords.
2428
2429 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2430 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2431 with the usual backslash ('\').
2432
2433 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2434 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2435 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2436 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2437 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2438
2439 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002440 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002441 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2442 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2443 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2444
2445 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002446 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002447 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2448 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2449 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2450 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2451
2452 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002453 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002454 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2455 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2456 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2457 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2458 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2459 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2460 trace).
2461
2462 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002463 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002464 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2465 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2466 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2467 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2468 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2469 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2470
2471 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2472 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2473 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2474 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2475 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2476 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2477 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2478 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2479
2480 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2481 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2482
2483 Examples :
2484 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002485 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002486
2487 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002488 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002489
2490 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002491 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002492
2493 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002494 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002496 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002497
2498
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002499http-check send-state
2500 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2502 yes | no | yes | yes
2503 Arguments : none
2504
2505 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2506 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2507 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2508 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2509 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2510
2511 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2512 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2513 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2514 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2515 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2516 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2517 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2518 checked in multiple backends.
2519
2520 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2521 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2522
2523 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2524 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2525 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2526 one fails.
2527
2528 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2529 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2530 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2531
2532 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2533 server's queue.
2534
2535 Example of a header received by the application server :
2536 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2537 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2538
2539 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2540
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002541http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002543 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2544
2545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2546 no | yes | yes | yes
2547
2548 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2549 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2550 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002551 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2552 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002553 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2554
2555 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2556 instance.
2557
2558 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002559 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2560 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2561 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002562
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002563 http-request allow if nagios
2564 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2565 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2566 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002567
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002568 Example:
2569 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002570
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002571 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002572
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002573 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2574 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002575
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002576http-send-name-header [<header>]
2577 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2578
2579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2580 yes | no | yes | yes
2581
2582 Arguments :
2583
2584 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2585
2586 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2587 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2588 is added with the header string proved.
2589
2590 See also : "server"
2591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002592id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002593 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2595 no | yes | yes | yes
2596 Arguments : none
2597
2598 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2599 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2600 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002601
2602
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002603ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2604 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2606 no | yes | yes | yes
2607
2608 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2609 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2610 and running).
2611
2612 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2613 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2614 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2615 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2616 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2617
2618 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2619 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2620
2621 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2622 "unless" condition is met.
2623
2624 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2625
2626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002627log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002628log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002629no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002630 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2632 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002633
2634 Prefix :
2635 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2636 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2637 prefix does not allow arguments.
2638
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002639 Arguments :
2640 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2641 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2642 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2643 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2644 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2645 parameter.
2646
2647 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2648 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2649
2650 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2651 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2652 standard syslog port).
2653
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002654 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2655 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2656 standard syslog port).
2657
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002658 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2659 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2660 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2661 appropriately writeable).
2662
2663 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2664
2665 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2666 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2667 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2668
2669 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2670 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2671 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002672 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2673 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2674 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2675 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2676 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677
2678 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2679
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002680 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2681 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2682 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002683
2684 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2685 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2686 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2687 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2688
2689 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2690 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002691
2692 Example :
2693 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002694 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2695 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002696
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002697log-format <string>
2698 Allows you to custom a log line.
2699
2700 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002702
2703maxconn <conns>
2704 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | no
2707 Arguments :
2708 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2709 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2710 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2711 closes.
2712
2713 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2714 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2715 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2716 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2717 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2718 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2719 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2720 properly tuned.
2721
2722 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2723 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2724 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2725
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002726 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2727
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002728 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2729
2730
2731mode { tcp|http|health }
2732 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 yes | yes | yes | yes
2735 Arguments :
2736 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2737 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2738 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2739 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2740
2741 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2742 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2743 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2744 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2745 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2746
2747 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002748 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2749 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2750 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2751 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2752 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2753 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2754 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002755
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002756 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2757 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2758 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002759
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002760 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002761 defaults http_instances
2762 mode http
2763
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002764 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002767monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002768 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 Arguments :
2772 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2773 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002774 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2776 backend and its backup.
2777
2778 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2779 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2780 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2781 servers in a list of backends.
2782
2783 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2784 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2785 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2786 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2787 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2788 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2789 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002790 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2791 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792
2793 Example:
2794 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002795 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2797 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2798 monitor-uri /site_alive
2799 monitor fail if site_dead
2800
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002801 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002802
2803
2804monitor-net <source>
2805 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 yes | yes | yes | no
2808 Arguments :
2809 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2810 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2811 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2812 followed by a mask.
2813
2814 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2815 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002816 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002817 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2818
2819 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2820 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2821 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2822 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002823 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2824 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2825 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002826
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002827 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2828 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2829 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2830 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2831 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2832 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002833
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002834 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2835 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002837 Example :
2838 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2839 frontend www
2840 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2841
2842 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2843
2844
2845monitor-uri <uri>
2846 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2848 yes | yes | yes | no
2849 Arguments :
2850 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2851 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2852
2853 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2854 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2855 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2856 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2857 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2858 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2859 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2860 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2861
2862 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2863 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2864 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2865 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2866 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2867 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2868
2869 Example :
2870 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2871 frontend www
2872 mode http
2873 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2874
2875 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002878option abortonclose
2879no option abortonclose
2880 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | no | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : none
2884
2885 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2886 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2887 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2888 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002889 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002890 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2891 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2892 encountered while delivering the response.
2893
2894 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2895 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2896 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2897 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2898 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2899 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002900 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002901 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002902 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002903 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2904 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2905 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2906
2907 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2908 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2909 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2910 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2911 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2912 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2913 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2914 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002915 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002916
2917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2919
2920 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2921
2922
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002923option accept-invalid-http-request
2924no option accept-invalid-http-request
2925 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2927 yes | yes | yes | no
2928 Arguments : none
2929
2930 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2931 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2932 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2933 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2934 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2935 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2936 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2937 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002938 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2939 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2940 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2941 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2942 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2943 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002944
2945 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2946 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2947 been confirmed.
2948
2949 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2950 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002951 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2952 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002953 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2954
2955 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2956 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2957
2958 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2959 stats socket.
2960
2961
2962option accept-invalid-http-response
2963no option accept-invalid-http-response
2964 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 yes | no | yes | yes
2967 Arguments : none
2968
2969 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2970 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2971 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2972 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2973 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2974 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2975 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2976 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2977 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2978
2979 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2980 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2981 been confirmed.
2982
2983 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2984 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2985 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2986 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2987
2988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2990
2991 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2992 stats socket.
2993
2994
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002995option allbackups
2996no option allbackups
2997 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2999 yes | no | yes | yes
3000 Arguments : none
3001
3002 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3003 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3004 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3005 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3006 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3007 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3008 order between the backup servers anymore.
3009
3010 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3011 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3012
3013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3015
3016
3017option checkcache
3018no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 yes | no | yes | yes
3022 Arguments : none
3023
3024 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3025 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003026 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003027 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3028 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003029 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003030
3031 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003032 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003033 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003034 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3035 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003036 to the client are :
3037 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003038 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003039 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003040 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3041 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3042 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3043 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3044 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3045 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3046 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3047 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3048 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3049 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3050 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3051
3052 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003053 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003054 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003055 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003056 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3057
3058 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3059 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003060 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003061 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3062
3063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3065
3066
3067option clitcpka
3068no option clitcpka
3069 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 yes | yes | yes | no
3072 Arguments : none
3073
3074 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3075 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3076 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3077 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3078
3079 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3080 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3081 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3082 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3083
3084 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3085 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3086 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3087 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3088 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3089
3090 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3091
3092 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3093 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3094 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3095
3096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3098
3099 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3100
3101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003102option contstats
3103 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | no
3106 Arguments : none
3107
3108 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3109 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3110 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3111 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3112 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3113 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3114 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3115
3116
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003117option dontlog-normal
3118no option dontlog-normal
3119 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 yes | yes | yes | no
3122 Arguments : none
3123
3124 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3125 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3126 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3127 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3128 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3129 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3130 logged.
3131
3132 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3133 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3134 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003136 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003137 logging.
3138
3139
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003140option dontlognull
3141no option dontlognull
3142 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3144 yes | yes | yes | no
3145 Arguments : none
3146
3147 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3148 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3149 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3150 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3151 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3152 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3153 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3154
3155 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3156 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3157 would not be logged.
3158
3159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003163
3164
3165option forceclose
3166no option forceclose
3167 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003169 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003170 Arguments : none
3171
3172 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3173 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3174 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3175 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3176 global session times in the logs.
3177
3178 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003179 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003180 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3181 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3182 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3183 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003184
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003185 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3186 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3187 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3188
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3191
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003192 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003193
3194
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003195option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003196 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3198 yes | yes | yes | yes
3199 Arguments :
3200 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3201 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003202 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003203 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204
3205 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3206 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3207 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3208 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3209 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3210 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3211 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003212 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3213 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3214 possible that the client has already brought one.
3215
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003216 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003217 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003218 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3219 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003220 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3221 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003222
3223 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3224 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3225 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3226 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3227 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3228 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3229 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3230
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003231 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3232 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3233 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3234 are under the control of the end-user.
3235
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003236 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003237 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3238 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003239 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3240 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3241 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003242
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003243 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3244 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3245 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3246 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3247 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003248
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003249 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003250 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3251 frontend www
3252 mode http
3253 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3254
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003255 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3256 backend www
3257 mode http
3258 option forwardfor header X-Client
3259
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003260 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3261 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003262
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003263
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003264option http-no-delay
3265no option http-no-delay
3266 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3268 yes | yes | yes | yes
3269 Arguments : none
3270
3271 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3272 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3273 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3274 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3275 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3276 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3277 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3278 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3279 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3280 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3281 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3282 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3283 affected.
3284
3285 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3286 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3287 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3288 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3289 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3290 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3291 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3292 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3293 latency environments.
3294
3295
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003296option http-pretend-keepalive
3297no option http-pretend-keepalive
3298 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | yes | yes | yes
3301 Arguments : none
3302
3303 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3304 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3305 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3306 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3307 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3308 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3309 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3310 consider the response complete.
3311
3312 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3313 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3314 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3315 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3316 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3317 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3318
3319 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3320 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3321 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3322 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3323 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3324 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3325 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3326
3327 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3328 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003329 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003330 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3331 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003332
3333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3335
3336 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3337
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003338
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003339option http-server-close
3340no option http-server-close
3341 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3343 yes | yes | yes | yes
3344 Arguments : none
3345
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003346 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3347 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3348 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3349 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3350 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3351 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3352 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3353 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3354 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3355 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3356 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3357 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003358
3359 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3360 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3361 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3362 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003363 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3364 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003365
3366 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3367 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003368 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3369 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3370 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003371
3372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3374
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003375 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3376 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003377
3378
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003379option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003380no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003381 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 yes | yes | yes | no
3384 Arguments : none
3385
3386 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3387 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3388 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3389 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3390 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3391 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3392 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3393
3394 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3395 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3396 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3397 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3398 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3399 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3400 request along its whole life.
3401
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003402 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3403 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3404 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3405 front of an existing proxy.
3406
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003407 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3408
3409 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3410 http-server-close".
3411
3412
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003413option httpchk
3414option httpchk <uri>
3415option httpchk <method> <uri>
3416option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3417 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3419 yes | no | yes | yes
3420 Arguments :
3421 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3422 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3423 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3424 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3425 ones.
3426
3427 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3428 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3429 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3430
3431 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3432 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3433 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3434 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3435 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3436
3437 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3438 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3439 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3440 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3441 the lack of any response.
3442
3443 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3444
3445 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3446 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3447 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3451 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3452 backend https_relay
3453 mode tcp
3454 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3455 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3456
3457 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003458 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3459 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003460
3461
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003462option httpclose
3463no option httpclose
3464 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
3467 Arguments : none
3468
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003469 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3470 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3471 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3472 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3473 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3474 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3475 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003476
3477 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003478 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003479 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3480 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3481 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3482 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3483 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003484
3485 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3486 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3487 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003488 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3489 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003490
3491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3493
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003494 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3495 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003496
3497
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003498option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003499 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003502 Arguments :
3503 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3504 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3505 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3506 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3507 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003508
3509 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3510 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3511 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3512 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3513 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3514 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3515 ports.
3516
3517 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3518
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3521 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3522 by default.
3523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003524 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003525
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003526
3527option http_proxy
3528no option http_proxy
3529 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 yes | yes | yes | yes
3532 Arguments : none
3533
3534 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3535 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3536 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3537 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3538 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3539
3540 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3541 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3542 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3543 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003544 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003545 be analyzed.
3546
3547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3549
3550 Example :
3551 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3552 backend direct_forward
3553 option httpclose
3554 option http_proxy
3555
3556 See also : "option httpclose"
3557
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003558
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003559option independent-streams
3560no option independent-streams
3561 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | yes | yes | yes
3564 Arguments : none
3565
3566 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3567 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3568 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3569 receive data or not.
3570
3571 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3572 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3573 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3574 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3575 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3576 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3577 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3578 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3579 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3580 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3581 socket buffers.
3582
3583 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3584 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3585 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3586 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3587 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3588
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003589 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3590 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3591 deprecated.
3592
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003593 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003594
3595
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003596option ldap-check
3597 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3599 yes | no | yes | yes
3600 Arguments : none
3601
3602 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3603 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3604 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3605 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3606
3607 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3608 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3609
3610 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3611 configure it.
3612
3613 Example :
3614 option ldap-check
3615
3616 See also : "option httpchk"
3617
3618
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003619option log-health-checks
3620no option log-health-checks
3621 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | no | yes | yes
3624 Arguments : none
3625
3626 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3627 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3628 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3629 of additional information is limited.
3630
3631 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3632 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3633
3634 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3635
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003636
3637option log-separate-errors
3638no option log-separate-errors
3639 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | yes | yes | no
3642 Arguments : none
3643
3644 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3645 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3646 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3647 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3648 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3649 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3650 provides very important information.
3651
3652 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3653 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3654 error logs.
3655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003656 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003657 logging.
3658
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003659
3660option logasap
3661no option logasap
3662 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | yes | yes | no
3665 Arguments : none
3666
3667 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3668 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3669 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3670 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3671 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3672 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3673 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003674 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003675 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3676 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3677
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003678 Examples :
3679 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3680 mode http
3681 option httplog
3682 option logasap
3683 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3684
3685 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3686 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3687 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3688 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003690 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003691 logging.
3692
3693
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003694option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3695 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003698 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003699 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3700 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003701
3702 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3703 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3704 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3705 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3706 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3707 in the MySQL table, like this :
3708
3709 USE mysql;
3710 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3711 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3712
3713 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3714 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3715 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3716 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3717 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3718 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3719 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3720 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3721 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3722
3723 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3724 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003725
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003726 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003727
3728 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3729 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3730 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3731 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3732 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3733 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3734
3735 See also: "option httpchk"
3736
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003737option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3738 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3740 yes | no | yes | yes
3741 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003742 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3743 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003744
3745 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3746 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3747 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3748 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3749
3750 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003751
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003752option nolinger
3753no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003754 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003757 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003758
3759 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3760 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3761 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3762 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3763 connections.
3764
3765 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3766 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3767 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3768 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3769 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3770 this too.
3771
3772 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3773 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3774 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3775
3776 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3777 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3778 for servers.
3779
3780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3782
3783
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003784option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3785 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 yes | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
3789 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3790 matching <network>
3791 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3792 header name.
3793
3794 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3795 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3796 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3797 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3798 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3799 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3800 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3801 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3802 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3803 possible that the client has already brought one.
3804
3805 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3806 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3807 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3808 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3809 header and requires different one.
3810
3811 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3812 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3813 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3814 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3815 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3816 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3817 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3818
3819 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3820 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3821 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3822 both are defined.
3823
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003824 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3825 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3826 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3827 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3828 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003829
3830 Examples :
3831 # Original Destination address
3832 frontend www
3833 mode http
3834 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3835
3836 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3837 backend www
3838 mode http
3839 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3840
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003841 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3842 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003843
3844
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003845option persist
3846no option persist
3847 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3849 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003850 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003851
3852 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3853 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3854 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3855 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3856 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3857 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3858 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3859 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3860 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3861 redirected to another valid server.
3862
3863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3865
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003866 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003867
3868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003869option redispatch
3870no option redispatch
3871 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3872 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003874 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003875
3876 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3877 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3878 be able to access the service anymore.
3879
3880 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3881 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3882
3883 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3884 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3885 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003887 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3888 "redisp" keywords.
3889
3890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3892
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003893 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003894
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003895
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003896option redis-check
3897 Use redis health checks for server testing
3898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3899 yes | no | yes | yes
3900 Arguments : none
3901
3902 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3903 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3904 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3905 find the "+PONG" response message.
3906
3907 Example :
3908 option redis-check
3909
3910 See also : "option httpchk"
3911
3912
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003913option smtpchk
3914option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3915 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3917 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003919 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3920 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3921 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3922
3923 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3924 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3925 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3926
3927 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3928 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3929 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3930 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3931 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3932 dead server.
3933
3934 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3935 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3936 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3937 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3938
3939 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3940 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3941 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3942 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3943 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3944
3945 Example :
3946 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3947
3948 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003951option socket-stats
3952no option socket-stats
3953
3954 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3956 yes | yes | yes | no
3957
3958 Arguments : none
3959
3960
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003961option splice-auto
3962no option splice-auto
3963 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3965 yes | yes | yes | yes
3966 Arguments : none
3967
3968 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3969 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3970 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3971 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003972 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003973 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3974 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3975 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3976 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3977
3978 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3979 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3980 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3981 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3982 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3983 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3984 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3985 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3986 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3987 keyword.
3988
3989 Example :
3990 option splice-auto
3991
3992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3994
3995 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3996 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3997
3998
3999option splice-request
4000no option splice-request
4001 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4003 yes | yes | yes | yes
4004 Arguments : none
4005
4006 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004007 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004008 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4009 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4010 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4011 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4012
4013 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4014
4015 Example :
4016 option splice-request
4017
4018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4020
4021 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4022 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4023
4024
4025option splice-response
4026no option splice-response
4027 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4029 yes | yes | yes | yes
4030 Arguments : none
4031
4032 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004033 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004034 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4035 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4036 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4037 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4038
4039 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4040
4041 Example :
4042 option splice-response
4043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
4047 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4048 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4049
4050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004051option srvtcpka
4052no option srvtcpka
4053 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | no | yes | yes
4056 Arguments : none
4057
4058 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4059 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4060 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4061 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4062
4063 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4064 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4065 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4066 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4067
4068 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4069 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4070 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4071 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4072 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4073
4074 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4075
4076 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4077 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4078 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4079
4080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4082
4083 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4084
4085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004086option ssl-hello-chk
4087 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4089 yes | no | yes | yes
4090 Arguments : none
4091
4092 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4093 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4094 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4095 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4096 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4097 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4098 hello message.
4099
4100 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4101 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4102 messages, which is appreciable.
4103
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004104 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4105 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4106 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004107
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004108 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4109
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004110
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004111option tcp-smart-accept
4112no option tcp-smart-accept
4113 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | no
4116 Arguments : none
4117
4118 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4119 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4120 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4121 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4122 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4123 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4124
4125 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4126 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4127 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4128 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4129
4130 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4131 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4132 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4133 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4134
4135 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4136 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4137 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4138
4139 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4140 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4141 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4142
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004143 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4144
4145
4146option tcp-smart-connect
4147no option tcp-smart-connect
4148 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4150 yes | no | yes | yes
4151 Arguments : none
4152
4153 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4154 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4155 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4156 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4157 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4158
4159 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4160 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4161 complex.
4162
4163 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4164 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4165 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4166
4167 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4168 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4169
4170 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4171
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004172
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004173option tcpka
4174 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4176 yes | yes | yes | yes
4177 Arguments : none
4178
4179 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4180 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4181 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4182 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4183
4184 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4185 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4186 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4187 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4188
4189 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4190 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4191 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4192 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4193 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4194
4195 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4196
4197 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4198 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4199 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4200 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4201 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4202 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4203 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4204 backends.
4205
4206 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4207
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004208
4209option tcplog
4210 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | yes | yes | yes
4213 Arguments : none
4214
4215 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4216 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4217 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4218 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4219 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4220 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4221 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4222 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4223
4224 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004226 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004227
4228
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004229option transparent
4230no option transparent
4231 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004233 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004234 Arguments : none
4235
4236 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4237 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4238 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4239 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4240 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4241 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4242 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4243 appropriate server.
4244
4245 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4246 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4247
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004248 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004249 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004250
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004251
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004252persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004253persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004254 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | no | yes | yes
4257 Arguments :
4258 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004259 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4260 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004261
4262 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4263 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4264 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4265 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4266 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4267 forwarded to this server.
4268
4269 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4270 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4271 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004272 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004273 a single "listen" section.
4274
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004275 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4276 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4277 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4278
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004279 Example :
4280 listen tse-farm
4281 bind :3389
4282 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4283 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4284 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4285 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4286 persist rdp-cookie
4287 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004288 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004289 balance rdp-cookie
4290 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4291 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4292
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004293 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4294 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004295
4296
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004297rate-limit sessions <rate>
4298 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | yes | yes | no
4301 Arguments :
4302 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4303 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4304
4305 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4306 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4307 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4308 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4309 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4310 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4311
4312 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4313 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4314 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4315 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4316
4317 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4318 listen smtp
4319 mode tcp
4320 bind :25
4321 rate-limit sessions 10
4322 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4323
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004324 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4325 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4326 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004327
4328 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4329
4330
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004331redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4332redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4333redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004334 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4336 no | yes | yes | yes
4337
4338 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004339 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004340
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004342 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4343 the HTTP "Location" header.
4344
4345 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4346 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4347 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4348 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4349 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4350 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4351
4352 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4353 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4354 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4355 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4356 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4357 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4358 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4359 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4360 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004361
4362 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4363 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4364 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4365 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4366 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4367 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4368 location with a GET method.
4369
4370 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4371 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4372
4373 - "drop-query"
4374 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4375 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4376 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4377 with a location-type redirect.
4378
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004379 - "append-slash"
4380 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4381 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4382 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4383 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4384
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004385 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4386 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4387 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4388 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4389 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4390 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4391 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4392
4393 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4394 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4395 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4396 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4397 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4398 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4399 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004400
4401 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4402 acl clear dst_port 80
4403 acl secure dst_port 8080
4404 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004405 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004406 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004407 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4408
4409 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004410 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4411 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4412 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004413 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004414
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004415 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4416 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4417 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4418
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004419 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004420 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004422 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004423
4424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004425redisp (deprecated)
4426redispatch (deprecated)
4427 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004430 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004431
4432 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4433 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4434 be able to access the service anymore.
4435
4436 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4437 redistribute them to a working server.
4438
4439 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4440 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4441 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004443 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4444 "option redispatch" instead.
4445
4446 See also : "option redispatch"
4447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004448
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004449reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004450 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4452 no | yes | yes | yes
4453 Arguments :
4454 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4455 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004456 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004457
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004458 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4459 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4460
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004461 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4462 the last header of an HTTP request.
4463
4464 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4465 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4466 responses.
4467
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004468 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4469 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4470 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4471
4472 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4473 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004474
4475
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004476reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4477reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004478 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4480 no | yes | yes | yes
4481 Arguments :
4482 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4483 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4484 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4485 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4486 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4487 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4488 ignores case.
4489
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004490 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4491 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4492
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4494 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4495 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4496 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004497 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004498
4499 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4500 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4501
4502 Example :
4503 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4504 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4505 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4506
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004507 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4508 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004509
4510
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004511reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4512reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 no | yes | yes | yes
4516 Arguments :
4517 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4518 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4519 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4520 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4521 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4522 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4523
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004524 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4525 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4526
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4528 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4529 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4530 next servers.
4531
4532 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4533 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4534 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4535
4536 Example :
4537 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4538 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4539 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004541 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4542 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004543
4544
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004545reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4546reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4549 no | yes | yes | yes
4550 Arguments :
4551 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4552 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4553 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4554 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4555 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4556 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4557 case.
4558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004559 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4560 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4561
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4563 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4564 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4565 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004566 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004567
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004568 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004569 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004570 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004571
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004572 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4573 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4574
4575 Example :
4576 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4577 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4578 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4579
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004580 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4581 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004582
4583
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004584reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4585reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4588 no | yes | yes | yes
4589 Arguments :
4590 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4591 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4592 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4593 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4594 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4595 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4596 case.
4597
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004598 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4599 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4600
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004601 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4602 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4603 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4604 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4605
4606 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4607 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4608
4609 Example :
4610 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4611 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4612 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4613 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4614
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004615 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4616 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004617
4618
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004619reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4620reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004621 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 no | yes | yes | yes
4624 Arguments :
4625 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4626 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4627 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4628 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4629 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4630 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4631
4632 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4633 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4634 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4635 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004636 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004637
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004638 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4639 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4640
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004641 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4642 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4643 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4644
4645 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4646 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4647 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4648 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4649 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4650
4651 Example :
4652 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004653 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004654 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4655 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4656
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004657 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4658 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004659
4660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004661reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4662reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004663 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 no | yes | yes | yes
4666 Arguments :
4667 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4668 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4669 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4670 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4671 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4672 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4673 ignores case.
4674
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004675 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4676 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4677
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004678 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4679 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004680 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4681 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4682 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004683 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4684 not set.
4685
4686 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4687 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4688 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4689 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4690 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004692 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004693 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4694 # block all others.
4695 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4696 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4697
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004698 # block bad guys
4699 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4700 reqitarpit . if badguys
4701
4702 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4703 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704
4705
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004706retries <value>
4707 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4708 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | no | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4712 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4713 default value is 3.
4714
4715 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4716 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4717 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4718
4719 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4720 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4721
4722 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4723 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4724
4725 See also : "option redispatch"
4726
4727
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004728rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004729 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 no | yes | yes | yes
4732 Arguments :
4733 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4734 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004735 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004736
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004737 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4738 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4739
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004740 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4741 the last header of an HTTP response.
4742
4743 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4744 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4745 responses.
4746
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004747 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4748 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004749
4750
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004751rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4752rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004753 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4755 no | yes | yes | yes
4756 Arguments :
4757 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4758 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4759 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4760 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4761 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4762 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4763 ignores case.
4764
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004765 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4766 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4767
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4769 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004770 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004771 client.
4772
4773 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4774 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4775 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4776
4777 Example :
4778 # remove the Server header from responses
4779 reqidel ^Server:.*
4780
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004781 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4782 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004783
4784
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004785rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4786rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 no | yes | yes | yes
4790 Arguments :
4791 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4792 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4793 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4794 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4795 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4796 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4797 ignores case.
4798
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004799 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4800 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4801
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004802 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4803 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4804 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4805 case-sensitive.
4806
4807 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004808 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4809 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4810 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004811
4812 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4813 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4814
4815 Example :
4816 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4817 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4818
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004819 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4820 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004821
4822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004823rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4824rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004825 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 no | yes | yes | yes
4828 Arguments :
4829 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4830 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4831 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4832 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4833 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4834 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4835 ignores case.
4836
4837 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4838 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4839 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4840 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004841 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004842
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004843 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4844 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4845
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004846 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4847 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4848 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4849
4850 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4851 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4852 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4853 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4854 are not case-sensitive.
4855
4856 Example :
4857 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4858 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4859
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004860 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4861 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004862
4863
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004864server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004865 Declare a server in a backend
4866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4867 no | no | yes | yes
4868 Arguments :
4869 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004870 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004871 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004872
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004873 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4874 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4875 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4876 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004877 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4878 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4879 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4880 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4881 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4882 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004884 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004885 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4886 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4887 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4888 adding this value to the client's port.
4889
4890 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4891 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004892 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004893
4894 Examples :
4895 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4896 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4897
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004898 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4899 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004900
4901
4902source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004903source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004904source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004905 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 yes | no | yes | yes
4908 Arguments :
4909 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4910 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4911 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4912 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4913
4914 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4915 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004916 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4917 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4918 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004919
4920 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4921 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4922 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4923 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4924 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4925 <addr>.
4926
4927 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4928 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4929 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4930 port.
4931
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004932 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4933 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4934 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4935 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4936 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4937 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4938 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4939 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4940 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4941 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4942 HTTP header.
4943
4944 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4945 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004946 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004947 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4948 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4949 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4950 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4951 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4952 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4953 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4954
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004955 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4956 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4957 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4958 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4959 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4960 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4961
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004962 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4963 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4964 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4965 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4966
4967 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4968 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4969 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4970 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4971 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4972 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4973
4974 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4975 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4976 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4977 there are two methods :
4978
4979 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4980 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4981 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4982 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4983 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4984 of the client ranges may be used.
4985
4986 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4987 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4988 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4989 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4990 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4991 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4992 same session.
4993
4994 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4995 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4996 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4997 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4998 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4999 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5000
5001 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5002 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5003 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005004 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005005
5006 Examples :
5007 backend private
5008 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5009 source 192.168.1.200
5010
5011 backend transparent_ssl1
5012 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5013 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5014
5015 backend transparent_ssl2
5016 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5017 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5018 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5019
5020 backend transparent_ssl3
5021 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5022 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5023 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5024
5025 backend transparent_smtp
5026 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5027 # with Tproxy version 4.
5028 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5029
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005030 backend transparent_http
5031 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5032 # proxy.
5033 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005035 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005036 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005038
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005039srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5040 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | no | yes | yes
5043 Arguments :
5044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5046 as explained at the top of this document.
5047
5048 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5049 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5050 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5051 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5052 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5053 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5054 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5055
5056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5058 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5059 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5060 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005061 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005062 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005063 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005064
5065 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5066 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5067 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5068 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5069 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5070 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5071
5072 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5073 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5074
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005075 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5076 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005077
5078
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005079stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5080 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | no | yes | yes
5083
5084 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5085 matched.
5086
5087 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5088 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5089
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005090 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5091 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5092 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5093
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005094 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5095 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5096 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5097 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005098
5099 Example :
5100 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5101 backend stats_localhost
5102 stats enable
5103 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5104
5105 Example :
5106 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5107 backend stats_auth
5108 stats enable
5109 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5110 stats admin if TRUE
5111
5112 Example :
5113 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5114 userlist stats-auth
5115 group admin users admin
5116 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5117 group readonly users haproxy
5118 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5119
5120 backend stats_auth
5121 stats enable
5122 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5123 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5124 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5125 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5126
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005127 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5128 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5129 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005130
5131
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005132stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5133 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136 Arguments :
5137 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5138
5139 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5140
5141 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5142 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5143 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5144 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5145 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5146 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5147
5148 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5149 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5150 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005151 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005152
5153 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5154 report using "stats scope".
5155
5156 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5157 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5158 unobvious parameters.
5159
5160 Example :
5161 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5162 backend public_www
5163 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5164 stats enable
5165 stats hide-version
5166 stats scope .
5167 stats uri /admin?stats
5168 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5169 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5170 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5171
5172 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5173 backend private_monitoring
5174 stats enable
5175 stats uri /admin?stats
5176 stats refresh 5s
5177
5178 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5179
5180
5181stats enable
5182 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | no | yes | yes
5185 Arguments : none
5186
5187 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5188 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5189 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5190 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5191 - stats auth : no authentication
5192 - stats scope : no restriction
5193
5194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5196 unobvious parameters.
5197
5198 Example :
5199 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5200 backend public_www
5201 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5202 stats enable
5203 stats hide-version
5204 stats scope .
5205 stats uri /admin?stats
5206 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5207 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5208 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5209
5210 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5211 backend private_monitoring
5212 stats enable
5213 stats uri /admin?stats
5214 stats refresh 5s
5215
5216 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5217
5218
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005219stats hide-version
5220 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005223 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005224
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005225 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5226 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5227 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5228 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5229 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5230 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5234 unobvious parameters.
5235
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005236 Example :
5237 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5238 backend public_www
5239 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005240 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005241 stats hide-version
5242 stats scope .
5243 stats uri /admin?stats
5244 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5245 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5246 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005247
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005248 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5249 backend private_monitoring
5250 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005251 stats uri /admin?stats
5252 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005253
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005254 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005255
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005256
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005257stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5259 Access control for statistics
5260
5261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5262 no | no | yes | yes
5263
5264 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5265 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5266 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5267 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5268 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5269 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5270
5271 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5272 instance.
5273
5274 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5275 about ACL usage.
5276
5277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005278stats realm <realm>
5279 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5281 yes | no | yes | yes
5282 Arguments :
5283 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5284 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5285 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5286
5287 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5288 using a backslash ('\').
5289
5290 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5291 only related to authentication.
5292
5293 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5294 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5295 unobvious parameters.
5296
5297 Example :
5298 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5299 backend public_www
5300 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5301 stats enable
5302 stats hide-version
5303 stats scope .
5304 stats uri /admin?stats
5305 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5306 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5307 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5308
5309 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5310 backend private_monitoring
5311 stats enable
5312 stats uri /admin?stats
5313 stats refresh 5s
5314
5315 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5316
5317
5318stats refresh <delay>
5319 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | no | yes | yes
5322 Arguments :
5323 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5324 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5325 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5326 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5327 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5328 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5329
5330 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5331 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5332 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5333 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5334
5335 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5336 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5337 unobvious parameters.
5338
5339 Example :
5340 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5341 backend public_www
5342 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5343 stats enable
5344 stats hide-version
5345 stats scope .
5346 stats uri /admin?stats
5347 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5348 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5349 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5350
5351 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5352 backend private_monitoring
5353 stats enable
5354 stats uri /admin?stats
5355 stats refresh 5s
5356
5357 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5358
5359
5360stats scope { <name> | "." }
5361 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | no | yes | yes
5364 Arguments :
5365 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5366 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5367 section in which the statement appears.
5368
5369 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5370 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5371 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5372 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5373 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5374 exists.
5375
5376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5378 unobvious parameters.
5379
5380 Example :
5381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5382 backend public_www
5383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5384 stats enable
5385 stats hide-version
5386 stats scope .
5387 stats uri /admin?stats
5388 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5391
5392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5393 backend private_monitoring
5394 stats enable
5395 stats uri /admin?stats
5396 stats refresh 5s
5397
5398 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005400
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005401stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005402 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5404 yes | no | yes | yes
5405
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005406 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005407 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5408
5409 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5410 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5411
5412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005414 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005415
5416 Example :
5417 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5418 backend private_monitoring
5419 stats enable
5420 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5421 stats uri /admin?stats
5422 stats refresh 5s
5423
5424 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5425 global section.
5426
5427
5428stats show-legends
5429 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5430 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5431 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5432 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5433 - IP (socket, server)
5434 - cookie (backend, server)
5435
5436 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5437 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005438 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005439
5440 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5441
5442
5443stats show-node [ <name> ]
5444 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5446 yes | no | yes | yes
5447 Arguments:
5448 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5449 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5450
5451 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5452 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005453 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005454
5455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5457 unobvious parameters.
5458
5459 Example:
5460 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5461 backend private_monitoring
5462 stats enable
5463 stats show-node Europe-1
5464 stats uri /admin?stats
5465 stats refresh 5s
5466
5467 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5468 section.
5469
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005470
5471stats uri <prefix>
5472 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5474 yes | no | yes | yes
5475 Arguments :
5476 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5477 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5478 query string.
5479
5480 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5481 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5482 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5483 possible to reach it in the application.
5484
5485 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005486 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005487 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5488 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5489 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5490 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5491
5492 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5493 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5494 an address or a port to statistics only.
5495
5496 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5497 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5498 unobvious parameters.
5499
5500 Example :
5501 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5502 backend public_www
5503 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5504 stats enable
5505 stats hide-version
5506 stats scope .
5507 stats uri /admin?stats
5508 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5509 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5510 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5511
5512 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5513 backend private_monitoring
5514 stats enable
5515 stats uri /admin?stats
5516 stats refresh 5s
5517
5518 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5519
5520
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005521stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5522 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005524 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005525
5526 Arguments :
5527 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5528 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5529 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5530 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5531
5532 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5533 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5534 the "stick-table" statement.
5535
5536 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5537 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5538 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5539 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5540 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5541
5542 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5543 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5544 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5545 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5546 transformation rules.
5547
5548 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5549 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5550 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5551 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5552 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5553 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5554 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5555
5556 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5557 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5558 ACL based conditions.
5559
5560 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5561 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5562 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5563 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5564
5565 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5566 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5567 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5568 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5569
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005570 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5571 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5572 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005574 Example :
5575 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5576 # last 30 minutes
5577 backend pop
5578 mode tcp
5579 balance roundrobin
5580 stick store-request src
5581 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5582 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5583 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5584
5585 backend smtp
5586 mode tcp
5587 balance roundrobin
5588 stick match src table pop
5589 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5590 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5591
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005592 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5593 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005594
5595
5596stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5597 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 no | no | yes | yes
5600
5601 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5602 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5603 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5604 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5605
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005606 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5607 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5608 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5609
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005610 Examples :
5611 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005612 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005613
5614 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5615 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5616 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5617
5618
5619 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5620 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5621 backend http
5622 mode http
5623 balance roundrobin
5624 stick on src table https
5625 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5626 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5627 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5628
5629 backend https
5630 mode tcp
5631 balance roundrobin
5632 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5633 stick on src
5634 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5635 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5636
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005637 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005638
5639
5640stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5641 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5643 no | no | yes | yes
5644
5645 Arguments :
5646 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5647 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5648 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5649 server is selected.
5650
5651 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5652 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5653 the "stick-table" statement.
5654
5655 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5656 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5657 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5658 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5659 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5660 address.
5661
5662 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5663 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5664 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5665 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5666 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5667 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5668 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5669 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5670 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5671 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5672
5673 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5674 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5675 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5676 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5677 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5678 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5679 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5680
5681 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5682 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5683 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5684 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5685
5686 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5687 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5688 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5689 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5690 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5691 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5692 another protocol or access method.
5693
5694 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5695 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5696 the request.
5697
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005698 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5699 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5700 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5701
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005702 Example :
5703 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5704 # last 30 minutes
5705 backend pop
5706 mode tcp
5707 balance roundrobin
5708 stick store-request src
5709 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5710 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5711 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5712
5713 backend smtp
5714 mode tcp
5715 balance roundrobin
5716 stick match src table pop
5717 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5718 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5719
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005720 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5721 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005722
5723
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005724stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005725 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5726 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005727 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005729 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005730
5731 Arguments :
5732 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5733 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5734 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5735 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5736
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005737 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5738 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5739 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5740 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5741
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005742 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5743 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5744 instance.
5745
5746 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5747 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5748 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5749 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5750 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5751 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005752 to 32 characters.
5753
5754 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5755 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5756 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5757 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5758 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5759 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005760
5761 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005762 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5763 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005764 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5765 increase.
5766
5767 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005768 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5769 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5770 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005771
5772 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5773 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5774 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5775 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5776 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5777 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5778 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5779 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5780 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5781 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5782 parameter (see below).
5783
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005784 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5785 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5786 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5787 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5788 soft restart.
5789
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005790 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5791
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005792 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5793 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5794 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5795 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5796 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005797 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005798 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5799 if not expiration delay is specified.
5800
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005801 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5802 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5803 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5804 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005805 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5806 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5807 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5808 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5809 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5810 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5811 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5812 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5813 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5814 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5815 types and their arguments.
5816
5817 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5818 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5819 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5820 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5821
5822 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5823 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5824 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5825 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5826
5827 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5828 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5829 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5830 they were received.
5831
5832 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5833 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5834 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5835 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5836 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5837
5838 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5839 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5840 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5841 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5842 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5843
5844 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5845 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5846 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5847
5848 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5849 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5850 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5851 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5852 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5853
5854 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5855 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5856 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5857 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5858 the client side.
5859
5860 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5861 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5862 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5863 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5864 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5865 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5866 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5867
5868 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5869 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5870 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5871 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5872 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5873 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5874 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5875
5876 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5877 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5878 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5879 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5880 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5881 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5882
5883 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5884 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5885 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5886 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5887
5888 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5889 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5890 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5891 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5892 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5893 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5894 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5895 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5896 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5897 recommended for better fairness.
5898
5899 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5900 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5901 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5902 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5903
5904 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5905 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5906 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5907 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5908 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5909 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5910 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5911 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5912 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5913 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005914
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005915 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5916 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005917 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5918 reference it.
5919
5920 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5921 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5922 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5923 as an exclusive stickiness.
5924
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005925 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5926 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5927 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5928 something that can be ignored.
5929
5930 Example:
5931 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5932 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5933 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5934 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5935
5936 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005937 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005938
5939
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005940stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5941 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5943 no | no | yes | yes
5944
5945 Arguments :
5946 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5947 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5948 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5949 server is selected.
5950
5951 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5952 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5953 the "stick-table" statement.
5954
5955 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5956 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5957 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5958 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5959
5960 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5961 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5962 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5963 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5964 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5965 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005966 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005967 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5968 rules.
5969
5970 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5971 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5972 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5973 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5974 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5975 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5976 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5977
5978 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5979 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5980 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5981 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5982
5983 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5984 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5985 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5986 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5987 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5988 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5989 another protocol or access method.
5990
5991 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5992
5993 Example :
5994 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5995 backend https
5996 mode tcp
5997 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005998 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005999 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006000
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006001 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6002 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6003
6004 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6005 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6006 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6007
6008 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6009 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006010
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006011 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6012 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6013 # at offset 44.
6014
6015 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6016 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6017
6018 # Learn on response if server hello.
6019 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006020
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006021 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6022 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6023
6024 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6025 extraction.
6026
6027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6029 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6031 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006032 Arguments :
6033 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6034 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6035 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006037 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006038
6039 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6040 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006041 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6042 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6043 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6044 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6045 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6046 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6049 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6050 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6051 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006053 Three types of actions are supported :
6054 - accept :
6055 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6056 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6057 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006059 - reject :
6060 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6061 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6062 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6063 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6064 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6065 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6066 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6067 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6068 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6069 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6070 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6071 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6074 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6075 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6076 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6077 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6078 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6079 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6080 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6081 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 These actions take one or two arguments :
6084 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6085 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6086 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6089 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6090 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6091 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6094 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6095 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6096 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6097 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6098 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6099 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6100 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6101 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6102 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006104 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6105 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6106 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006108 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6109 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6110 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006113 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006114 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006116 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6117 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6118 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6121 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6122 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006123
6124 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006126 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006127
6128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006129tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6130 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006132 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006133 Arguments :
6134 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6135 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6136 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006138 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006140 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6141 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6142 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6143 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6144 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006146 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6147 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6148 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6149 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6150 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6151 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6152 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6153 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6154 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006156 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6157 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6158 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6159 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006161 Three types of actions are supported :
6162 - accept :
6163 - reject :
6164 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006166 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6167 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006169 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6170 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6171 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6172 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6173 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6174 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006176 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006177 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6178 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006180 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006181 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6182 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6183 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6184 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6185 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006186
6187 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006188 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6189 # and reject everything else.
6190 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6191 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006192 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006193 tcp-request content reject
6194
6195 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006196 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6197 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6198 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006199 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006200
6201 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6202 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6203 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006204 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006205 tcp-request content reject
6206
6207 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6208 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6209
6210 frontend http
6211 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6212 # protecting all our sites
6213 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6214 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6215 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6216 ...
6217 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6218
6219 backend http_dynamic
6220 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6221 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6222 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6223 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6224 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6225 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6226 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006228 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006229
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006230 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006231
6232
6233tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6234 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006236 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006237 Arguments :
6238 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6239 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6240 as explained at the top of this document.
6241
6242 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6243 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6244 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6245 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6246 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6247
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006248 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6249 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6250 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6251 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6252
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006253 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6254 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006255 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006256 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006257 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6258 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6259 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6260 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006261
6262 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6263 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6264 it pass through unaffected.
6265
6266 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6267 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6268 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006269 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006270 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6271 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006272 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6273 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6274 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006275
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006276 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006277 "timeout client".
6278
6279
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006280tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6281 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6283 no | no | yes | yes
6284 Arguments :
6285 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6286 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6287 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6288
6289 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6290
6291 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6292 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6293 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6294 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006295 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006296
6297 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6298
6299 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6300 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6301 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6302 inserted.
6303
6304 Two types of actions are supported :
6305 - accept :
6306 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6307 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6308 the rules evaluation.
6309
6310 - reject :
6311 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6312 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006313 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006314
6315 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6316 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6317 for changing the default action to a reject.
6318
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006319 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6320 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6321 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6322 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006323 period.
6324
6325 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6326
6327 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6328
6329
6330tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6331 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 no | no | yes | yes
6334 Arguments :
6335 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6336 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6337 as explained at the top of this document.
6338
6339 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6340
6341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006342timeout check <timeout>
6343 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6344 established.
6345
6346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6347 yes | no | yes | yes
6348 Arguments:
6349 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6351 as explained at the top of this document.
6352
6353 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6354 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6355 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6356 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006357 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6358 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6359 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006360
6361 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6362 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6363
6364 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6365 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006366 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006367
6368 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6369 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6370 forget about it.
6371
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006372 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6373 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006374
6375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006376timeout client <timeout>
6377timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6378 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | yes | yes | no
6381 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6384 as explained at the top of this document.
6385
6386 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6387 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6388 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6389 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6390 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6391 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6392 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6393 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006394 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006395 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006396 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6397 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6398 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006399
6400 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6401 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6402 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6403 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6404 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6405 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6406
6407 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6408 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6409 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6410
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006411 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006412
6413
6414timeout connect <timeout>
6415timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6416 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6418 yes | no | yes | yes
6419 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006420 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006421 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6422 as explained at the top of this document.
6423
6424 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006425 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006426 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006427 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006428 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6429 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006430
6431 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6432 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6433 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6434 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6435 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6436 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6437
6438 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6439 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6440 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6441
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006442 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6443 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006444
6445
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006446timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6447 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | yes | yes | yes
6450 Arguments :
6451 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6452 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6453 as explained at the top of this document.
6454
6455 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6456 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6457 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6458 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6459 once the request has started to present itself.
6460
6461 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6462 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6463 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6464 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6465 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6466
6467 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6468 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6469 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6470 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6471
6472 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6473 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6474 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6475 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6476 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006477 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006478
6479 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6480 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6481 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6482 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6483
6484 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6485
6486
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006487timeout http-request <timeout>
6488 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006490 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006491 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006492 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006493 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6494 as explained at the top of this document.
6495
6496 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6497 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6498 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6499 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6500 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6501 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6502 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6503 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6504
6505 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6506 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006507 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6508 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006509
6510 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6511 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6512 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6513 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6514 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6515
6516 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006517 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6518 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6519 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006520
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006521 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006522
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523
6524timeout queue <timeout>
6525 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6527 yes | no | yes | yes
6528 Arguments :
6529 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6530 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6531 as explained at the top of this document.
6532
6533 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6534 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6535 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6536 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6537 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6538
6539 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6540 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6541 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6542 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6543
6544 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6545
6546
6547timeout server <timeout>
6548timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6549 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | no | yes | yes
6552 Arguments :
6553 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6554 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6555 as explained at the top of this document.
6556
6557 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6558 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6559 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6560 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6561 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6562 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6563 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6564
6565 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6566 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6567 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6568 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6569 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006570 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006571 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006572 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6573 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6574 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6575 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006576
6577 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6578 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6579 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6580 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6581 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6582 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6583
6584 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6585 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6586 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6587
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006588 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006589
6590
6591timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006592 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6594 yes | yes | yes | yes
6595 Arguments :
6596 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6597 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6598 as explained at the top of this document.
6599
6600 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6601 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6602 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6603
6604 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6605 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6606 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6607 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006608 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006609
6610 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6611
6612
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006613timeout tunnel <timeout>
6614 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6616 yes | no | yes | yes
6617 Arguments :
6618 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6620 as explained at the top of this document.
6621
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006622 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006623 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6624 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6625 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6626 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6627 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6628 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6629 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6630 specified.
6631
6632 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6633 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6634 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6635 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6636 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6637
6638 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6639 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6640 forget about it.
6641
6642 Example :
6643 defaults http
6644 option http-server-close
6645 timeout connect 5s
6646 timeout client 30s
6647 timeout client 30s
6648 timeout server 30s
6649 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6650
6651 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6652
6653
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006654transparent (deprecated)
6655 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006657 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6661 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6662 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6663 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6664 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6665 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6666 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6667 appropriate server.
6668
6669 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6670
6671 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6672 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6673
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006674 See also: "option transparent"
6675
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006676unique-id-format <string>
6677 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6679 yes | yes | yes | no
6680 Arguments :
6681 <string> is a log-format string.
6682
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006683 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6684 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6685 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6686 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006687
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006688 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6689 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6690 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6691 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6692 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6693 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6694 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6695 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006697 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6698 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006699
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006700 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006701
6702 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6703
6704 will generate:
6705
6706 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6707
6708 See also: "unique-id-header"
6709
6710unique-id-header <name>
6711 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6713 yes | yes | yes | no
6714 Arguments :
6715 <name> is the name of the header.
6716
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006717 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6718 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006719
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006720 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006721
6722 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6723 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6724
6725 will generate:
6726
6727 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6728
6729 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006730
6731use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6732use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006733 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 no | yes | yes | no
6736 Arguments :
6737 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006739 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006740
6741 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6742 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6743 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006744 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6745 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6746 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6747 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006748
6749 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6750 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6751 assign the backend.
6752
6753 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6754 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6755 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6756 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6757 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6758 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6759
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006760 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006761 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006762 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6763 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6764 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6765
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006766 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006767
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006768
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006769use-server <server> if <condition>
6770use-server <server> unless <condition>
6771 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 no | no | yes | yes
6774 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006775 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006776
6777 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6778
6779 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6780 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6781 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6782
6783 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6784 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6785 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6786 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6787 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6788 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6789 matches will assign the server.
6790
6791 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6792 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6793 with the next rules until one matches.
6794
6795 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6796 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6797 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6798 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6799
6800 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6801 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6802 stripped.
6803
6804 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6805 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6806 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6807 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6808
6809 Example :
6810 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6811 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6812 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6813 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6814 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6815 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6816 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6817 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6818 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6819
6820 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6821
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006822
68235. Bind and Server options
6824--------------------------
6825
6826The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6827depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6828settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6829written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6830described in this section.
6831
6832
68335.1. Bind options
6834-----------------
6835
6836The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6837as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6838no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6839parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6840while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6841provided immediately after the setting name.
6842
6843The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6844
6845accept-proxy
6846 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6847 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6848 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6849 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6850 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6851 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6852 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6853 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6854 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6855 usable.
6856
6857backlog <backlog>
6858 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6859 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6860
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006861ecdhe <named curve>
6862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6863 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6864 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6865
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006866ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6868 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6869 client's certificate.
6870
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006871ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6873 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6874 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6875 error is ignored.
6876
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006877ciphers <ciphers>
6878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6879 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6880 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6881 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6882 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6883
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006884crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6886 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6887 to verify client's certificate.
6888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006889crt <cert>
6890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6891 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6892 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006893 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6894 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6895 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6896 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6897 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6898 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6899 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6900 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006901 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006902 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6903 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6904 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6905 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6906 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006907
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006908crt-ignore-err <errors>
6909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6910 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6911 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6912 error is ignored.
6913
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006914defer-accept
6915 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6916 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6917 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6918 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6919 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6920 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6921 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6922 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6923 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6924 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6925 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6926
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006927force-sslv3
6928 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6929 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6930 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6931
6932force-tlsv10
6933 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6934 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6935
6936force-tlsv11
6937 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6938 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6939
6940force-tlsv12
6941 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6942 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6943
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006944gid <gid>
6945 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6946 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6947 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6948 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6949 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6950
6951group <group>
6952 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6953 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6954 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6955 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6956 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6957
6958id <id>
6959 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6960 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6961 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6962 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6963
6964interface <interface>
6965 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6966 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6967 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6968 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6969 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6970 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6971 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6972 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6973
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006974level <level>
6975 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6976 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6977 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6978 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6979 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6980 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6981 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6982 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6983 counters).
6984 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6985 all counters).
6986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006987maxconn <maxconn>
6988 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6989 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6990 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6991 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6992 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6993 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6994 eat all memory.
6995
6996mode <mode>
6997 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6998 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6999 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7000 UNIX sockets.
7001
7002mss <maxseg>
7003 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7004 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7005 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7006 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7007 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7008 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7009 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7010 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7011 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7012 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7013 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7014
7015name <name>
7016 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7017 page.
7018
7019nice <nice>
7020 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7021 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7022 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7023 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7024 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7025 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7026 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7027 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7028 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7029 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7030 one for an RDP socket.
7031
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007032no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7034 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7035 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007036 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7037 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007038
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007039no-tls-tickets
7040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7041 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7042 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7043 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7044
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007045no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007047 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7048 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7049 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7050 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007051
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007052no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007054 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7055 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7056 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7057 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007058
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007059no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007061 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7062 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7063 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7064 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007065
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007066npn <protocols>
7067 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7068 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7069 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7070 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7071 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7072
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007073ssl
7074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7075 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7076 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7077 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7078 to deciphered contents.
7079
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007080tfo
7081 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7082 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7083 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7084 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7085 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7086 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7087 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7088 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7089 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7090
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007091transparent
7092 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7093 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7094 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7095 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7096 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7097 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7098 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7099 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7100 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7101 so check for support with your vendor.
7102
7103uid <uid>
7104 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7105 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7106 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7107 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7108 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7109
7110user <user>
7111 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7112 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7113 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7114 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7115 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7116
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007117verify [none|optional|required]
7118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7119 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7120 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7121 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7122 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007123 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7124 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7125 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7126 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007127
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020071285.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007129------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007131The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7132which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7133arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7134settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7135after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7136Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7137address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007139 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007140 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007142The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007143
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007144addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007145 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7146 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7147 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7148 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7149 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007151 Supported in default-server: No
7152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153backup
7154 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7155 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7156 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7157 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7158 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7159 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007161 Supported in default-server: No
7162
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007163ca-file <cafile>
7164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7165 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7166 server's certificate.
7167
7168 Supported in default-server: No
7169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007170check
7171 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007172 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7173 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7174 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7175 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7176 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7177 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7178 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7179 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7180 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7181 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007183 Supported in default-server: No
7184
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007185check-send-proxy
7186 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7187 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7188 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7189 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7190 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7191 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7192 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7193
7194 Supported in default-server: No
7195
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007196check-ssl
7197 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7198 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7199 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7200 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7201 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7202 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7203 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7204 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7205 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7206
7207 Supported in default-server: No
7208
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007209ciphers <ciphers>
7210 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7211 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7212 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7213 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7214 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7215 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7216 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7217 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7218
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007219 Supported in default-server: No
7220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007221cookie <value>
7222 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7223 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7224 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7225 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7226 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7227 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7228 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007230 Supported in default-server: No
7231
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007232crl-file <crlfile>
7233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7234 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7235 to verify server's certificate.
7236
7237 Supported in default-server: No
7238
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007239crt <cert>
7240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7241 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7242 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7243 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7244 certificate request.
7245
7246 Supported in default-server: No
7247
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007248disabled
7249 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7250 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7251 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7252 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7253 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7254
7255 Supported in default-server: No
7256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007257error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007258 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7259 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7260 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007262 Supported in default-server: Yes
7263
7264 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007266fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007267 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7268 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7269 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007271 Supported in default-server: Yes
7272
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007273force-sslv3
7274 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7275 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7276 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7277
7278 Supported in default-server: No
7279
7280force-tlsv10
7281 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7282 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7283
7284 Supported in default-server: No
7285
7286force-tlsv11
7287 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7288 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7289
7290 Supported in default-server: No
7291
7292force-tlsv12
7293 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7294 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7295
7296 Supported in default-server: No
7297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007298id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007299 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7300 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7301 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007303 Supported in default-server: No
7304
7305inter <delay>
7306fastinter <delay>
7307downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007308 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7309 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7310 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7311 between checks depending on the server state :
7312
7313 Server state | Interval used
7314 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7315 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7316 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7317 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7318 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7319 or yet unchecked. |
7320 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7321 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7322 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007324 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7325 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7326 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7327 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7328 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7329 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7330 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7331 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7332 servers.
7333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007334 Supported in default-server: Yes
7335
7336maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007337 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7338 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7339 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7340 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7341 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7342 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7343 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7344 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007346 Supported in default-server: Yes
7347
7348maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007349 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7350 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7351 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7352 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7353 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7354 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7355 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007357 Supported in default-server: Yes
7358
7359minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007360 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7361 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7362 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7363 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7364 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7365 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007366 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007367 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007369 Supported in default-server: Yes
7370
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007371no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007372 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7373 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007374 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007375
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007376 Supported in default-server: No
7377
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007378no-tls-tickets
7379 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7380 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7381 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7382 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7383
7384 Supported in default-server: No
7385
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007386no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007387 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007388 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7389 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007390 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7391 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007392
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007393 Supported in default-server: No
7394
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007395no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007396 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007397 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7398 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007399 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7400 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007401
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007402 Supported in default-server: No
7403
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007404no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007405 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007406 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7407 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007408 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7409 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007410
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007411 Supported in default-server: No
7412
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007413non-stick
7414 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7415 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7416 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7417
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007418 Supported in default-server: No
7419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007420observe <mode>
7421 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7422 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7423 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7424 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7425 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7426 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007427 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007429 Supported in default-server: No
7430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007431 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007433on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007434 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7435 Currently, four modes are available:
7436 - fastinter: force fastinter
7437 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7438 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7439 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7440 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007442 Supported in default-server: Yes
7443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007444 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7445
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007446on-marked-down <action>
7447 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7448 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007449 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7450 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7451 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7452 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7453 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7454 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7455 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7456 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007457
7458 Actions are disabled by default
7459
7460 Supported in default-server: Yes
7461
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007462on-marked-up <action>
7463 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7464 Currently one action is available:
7465 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7466 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7467 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7468 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7469 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7470 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7471 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7472 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7473
7474 Actions are disabled by default
7475
7476 Supported in default-server: Yes
7477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007478port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007479 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7480 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7481 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7482 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7483 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7484 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007486 Supported in default-server: Yes
7487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007488redir <prefix>
7489 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7490 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7491 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7492 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7493 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7494 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7495 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7496 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007497 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007498 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7499 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7500 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7501 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7502 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7503
7504 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007506 Supported in default-server: No
7507
7508rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007509 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7510 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7511 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007513 Supported in default-server: Yes
7514
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007515send-proxy
7516 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7517 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7518 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7519 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7520 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7521 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7522 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7523 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7524 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007525 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7526 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7527 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7528 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7529 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007530
7531 Supported in default-server: No
7532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007533slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007534 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7535 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7536 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7537 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7538 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7539 parameters :
7540
7541 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7542 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7543
7544 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7545 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7546 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7547 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7548
7549 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7550 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7551 seen as failed.
7552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007553 Supported in default-server: Yes
7554
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007555source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007556source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007557source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007558 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7559 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7560 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7561 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7562
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007563 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7564 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7565 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7566 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7567 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7568 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7569 server.
7570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007571 Supported in default-server: No
7572
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007573ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007574 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7575 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7576 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7577 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7578 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7579 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7580 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7581 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7582
7583 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007585track [<proxy>/]<server>
7586 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7587 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7588 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7589 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7590 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007592 Supported in default-server: No
7593
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007594verify [none|required]
7595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7596 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7597 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7598 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7599 is aborted.
7600
7601 Supported in default-server: No
7602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007603weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007604 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7605 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7606 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007607 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7608 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7609 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7610 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7611 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7612 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007614 Supported in default-server: Yes
7615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007616
76176. HTTP header manipulation
7618---------------------------
7619
7620In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7621response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7622request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7623which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7624against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7625to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7626passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7627headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7628never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7629
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007630There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7631(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7632rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7633messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7634in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007635happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007636add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7637normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007639This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7640in section 4.2 :
7641
7642 - reqadd <string>
7643 - reqallow <search>
7644 - reqiallow <search>
7645 - reqdel <search>
7646 - reqidel <search>
7647 - reqdeny <search>
7648 - reqideny <search>
7649 - reqpass <search>
7650 - reqipass <search>
7651 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7652 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7653 - reqtarpit <search>
7654 - reqitarpit <search>
7655 - rspadd <string>
7656 - rspdel <search>
7657 - rspidel <search>
7658 - rspdeny <search>
7659 - rspideny <search>
7660 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7661 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7662
7663With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7664is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7665parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7666prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7667Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7668
7669 \t for a tab
7670 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7671 \n for a new line (LF)
7672 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7673 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7674 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7675 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7676 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7677
7678The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7679portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7680above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7681regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76829 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7683is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7684
7685The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7686after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7687
7688Notes related to these keywords :
7689---------------------------------
7690 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7691 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7692 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7693
7694 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7695 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7696 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7697
7698 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7699 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7700 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7701 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7702 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7703
7704 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7705 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7706 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7707 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7708 useless headers before adding new ones.
7709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007710 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007711 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7712
7713 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7714 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7715 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7716
7717 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7718 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007719 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007720
7721
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077227. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7723------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007724
7725The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7726content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7727from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7728simple :
7729
7730 - define test criteria with sets of values
7731 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7732
7733The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7734
7735In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7736
7737 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7738
7739This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7740Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7741and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7742an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7743of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7744
7745ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7746'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7747which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7748
7749There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7750performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7751
7752The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7753
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007754 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7755 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007756 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7757
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007758The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7759specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7760possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007761multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7762be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7763needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7764space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7765match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7766lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7767duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007768to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007769instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007770
7771 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7772
7773In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7774the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7775case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7776too.
7777
7778Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7779a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7780ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7781
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007782Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007783
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007784 - integers or integer ranges
7785 - strings
7786 - regular expressions
7787 - IP addresses and networks
7788
7789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077907.1. Matching integers
7791----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007792
7793Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7794that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7795expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7796may be omitted.
7797
7798For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7799unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7800representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7801
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007802As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7803two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7804instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7805ranges and operators.
7806
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007807For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007808operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7809Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7810of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007812Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007813
7814 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7815 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7816 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7817 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7818 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007820For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007821
7822 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7823
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007824This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7825
7826 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7827
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078297.2. Matching strings
7830---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007831
7832String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7833exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7834characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7835string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7836to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007837before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007838
7839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078407.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7841-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007842
7843Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7844they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7845possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7846passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7847the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007848the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7849match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007850
7851
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020078527.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007853----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007854
7855IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7856netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7857within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007858host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007859difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7860at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7861does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7862parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007863
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007864IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7865Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7866trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7867IPv6 patterns.
7868
7869HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7870following situations :
7871 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7872 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7873 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7874 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7875 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7876 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7877 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7878 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7879 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7880 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7881
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078837.5. Available matching criteria
7884--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078867.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7887------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007888
7889A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7890analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007891addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007892
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007893always_false
7894 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7895 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7896
7897always_true
7898 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7899 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7900
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007901avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007902avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007903 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7904 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7905 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7906 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7907 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7908 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7909 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7910 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7911 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7912 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7913 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007914
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007915be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007916be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007917 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7918 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7919 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7920 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7921 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007922
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007923be_id <integer>
7924 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7925 backend it was called.
7926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007927be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007928be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007929 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7930 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7931 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7932 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7933 sucking of an online dictionary).
7934
7935 Example :
7936 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7937 backend dynamic
7938 mode http
7939 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7940 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007941
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007942connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007943connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007944 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007945 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007946 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7947
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007948 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7949 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007950
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007951 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007952 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7953 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7954 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7955 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7956 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007957 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007958
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007959 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7960 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7961 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7962 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007964dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007965 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7966 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007967
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007968dst_conn <integer>
7969 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7970 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7971 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7972 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7973 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7974 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7975
7976dst_port <integer>
7977 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7978 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7979
7980fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007981fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007982 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7983 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7984 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7985 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7986 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7987 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7988 criteria.
7989
7990fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007991 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007992 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007993
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007994fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007995fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007996 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7997 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7998 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7999 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
8000 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
8001 the rate to go down below the limit.
8002
8003 Example :
8004 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
8005 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
8006 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
8007 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
8008 frontend mail
8009 bind :25
8010 mode tcp
8011 maxconn 100
8012 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
8013 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
8014 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8015 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008017nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008018nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008019 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8020 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8021 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8022 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8023 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008024
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008025queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008026queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008027 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8028 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8029 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8030 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8031 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8032 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8033 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008035sc1_bytes_in_rate
8036sc2_bytes_in_rate
8037 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8038 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8039 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8040
8041sc1_bytes_out_rate
8042sc2_bytes_out_rate
8043 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8044 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8045 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8046
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008047sc1_clr_gpc0
8048sc2_clr_gpc0
8049 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8050 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8051 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8052 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8053 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8054 was verified :
8055
8056 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8057 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8058 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8059 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8060 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8061 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8062 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8063
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008064sc1_conn_cnt
8065sc2_conn_cnt
8066 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8067 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8068
8069sc1_conn_cur
8070sc2_conn_cur
8071 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8072 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8073 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8074
8075sc1_conn_rate
8076sc2_conn_rate
8077 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8078 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8079 See also src_conn_rate.
8080
8081sc1_get_gpc0
8082sc2_get_gpc0
8083 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8084 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8085
8086sc1_http_err_cnt
8087sc2_http_err_cnt
8088 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8089 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8090 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8091
8092sc1_http_err_rate
8093sc2_http_err_rate
8094 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8095 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8096 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8097 src_http_err_rate.
8098
8099sc1_http_req_cnt
8100sc2_http_req_cnt
8101 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8102 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8103 src_http_req_cnt.
8104
8105sc1_http_req_rate
8106sc2_http_req_rate
8107 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8108 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8109 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8110 src_http_req_rate.
8111
8112sc1_inc_gpc0
8113sc2_inc_gpc0
8114 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8115 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8116 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8117 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8118 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8119 when a first ACL was verified :
8120
8121 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8122 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8123 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8124
8125sc1_kbytes_in
8126sc2_kbytes_in
8127 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8128 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8129 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8130 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8131
8132sc1_kbytes_out
8133sc2_kbytes_out
8134 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8135 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8136 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8137 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8138
8139sc1_sess_cnt
8140sc2_sess_cnt
8141 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8142 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8143 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8144 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008145 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008146 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8147
8148sc1_sess_rate
8149sc2_sess_rate
8150 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8151 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8152 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8153 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8154 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008155 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008157so_id <integer>
8158 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8159
8160src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008161 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8162 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8163 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008164
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008165src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008166src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008167 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8168 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8169 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008170 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008171
8172src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008173src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008174 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8175 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8176 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008177 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008178
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008179src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8180src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8181 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8182 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8183 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8184 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8185 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8186 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8187
8188 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8189 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8190 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8191 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8192 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8193 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8194 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8195
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008196src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008197src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008198 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8199 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8200 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008201 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008202
8203src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008204src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008205 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8206 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8207 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008208 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008209
8210src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008211src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008212 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8213 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8214 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008215 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008216
8217src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008218src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008219 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8220 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8221 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008223
8224src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008225src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008226 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8227 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8228 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008229 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008230
8231src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008232src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008233 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8234 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8235 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8236 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008237 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008238
8239src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008240src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008241 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8242 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8243 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008244 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008245
8246src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008247src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008248 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8249 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8250 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8251 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008252 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008253
8254src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008255src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008256 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8257 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8258 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8259 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8260 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8261 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8262
8263 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8264 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008265 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008266
8267src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008268src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008269 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8270 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8271 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8272 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008273 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008274
8275src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008276src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008277 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8278 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8279 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8280 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008281 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008282
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008283src_port <integer>
8284 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008285
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008286src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008287src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008288 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8289 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8290 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8291 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008292 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008293
8294src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008295src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008296 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8297 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8298 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8299 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008300 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008301
8302src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008303src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008304 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008305 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8306 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008307 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8308 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8309 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008310 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008311
8312 Example :
8313 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8314 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8315 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8316 listen ssh
8317 bind :22
8318 mode tcp
8319 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008320 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008321 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8322 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8323
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008324srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008325 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8326 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8327 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8328 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8329
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008330srv_id <integer>
8331 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8332
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008333srv_is_up(<server>)
8334srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8335 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8336 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8337 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8338 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8339 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8340 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8341 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8342 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8343
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008344table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008345table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008346 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8347 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8348
8349table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008350table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008351 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8352 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8353 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083567.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8357---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008358
8359A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8360during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008361through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8362keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008363
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008364rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8365 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8366 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8367 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008368 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8369 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8370 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008371
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008372req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008373 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008374 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8375 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8376 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8377 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8378 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8379 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8380
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008381req_proto_http
8382 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8383 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008384 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008385 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8386 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8387
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008388req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008389req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008390 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8391 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8392 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8393 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8394 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8395 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8396 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8397 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8398
8399req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008400req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008401 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8402 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8403 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8404 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8405 cookies.
8406
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008407req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8408 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8409 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8410 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008411 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8412 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8413 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008414
8415req_ssl_sni <string>
8416 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8417 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8418 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8419 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8420 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8421 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8422 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008423 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8424 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008425 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008426 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008427
8428 Examples :
8429 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8430 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8431 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8432 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8433 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8434
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008435req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8436 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8437 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8438 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8439 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8440 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8441 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008442 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8443 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008444 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008445 option.
8446
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008447ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8448 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8449 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8450 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8451 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8452 during this verification process.
8453
8454ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8455 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8456 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8457 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8458 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8459
8460ssl_c_err <integer>
8461 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8462 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8463 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8464 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8465
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008466ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8467ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8468 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8469 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8470 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8471 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8472 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8473 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8474 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8475 DN matches the specified string.
8476
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008477ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8478 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8479 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8480 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8481
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008482ssl_c_notafter <string>
8483 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8484 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8485 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8486
8487ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8488 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8489 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8490 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8491
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008492ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8493ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8494 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8495 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8496 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8497 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8498 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8499 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8500 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8501 DN matches the specified string.
8502
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008503ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8504 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8505 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8506 the value written in hexa.
8507
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008508ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8509 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8510 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8511 by the client matches the string.
8512
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008513ssl_c_verify <integer>
8514 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8515 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8516 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8517
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008518ssl_c_version <integer>
8519 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8520 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8521 the value.
8522
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008523ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8524ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8525 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8526 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8527 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8528 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8529 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8530 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8531 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8532 DN matches the specified string.
8533
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008534ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8535 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8536 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8537 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8538
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008539ssl_f_notafter <string>
8540 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8541 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8542 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8543
8544ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8545 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8546 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8547 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8548
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008549ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8550ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8551 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8552 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8553 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8554 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8555 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8556 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8557 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8558 DN matches the specified string.
8559
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008560ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8561 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8562 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8563 the value written in hexa.
8564
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008565ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8566 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8567 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8568 by the frontend matches the string.
8569
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008570ssl_f_version <integer>
8571 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8572 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8573 the value.
8574
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008575ssl_fc
8576 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8577 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8578 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8579
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008580ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8581 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8582 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8583
8584ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8585 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8586 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8587
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008588ssl_fc_has_crt
8589 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8590 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8591
8592ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008593 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008594 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8595 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8596 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8597 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008598
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008599ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008600 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8601 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8602 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8603 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008604 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8605 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8606 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008607
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008608ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8609 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8610 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8611
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008612ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008613 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8614 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8615 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8616 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008617 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8618 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008619 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8620 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8621 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008622
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008623ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008624 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8625 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8626 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8627 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008628 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8629 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8630 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8631 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008632
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008633ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008634 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8635 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8636 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8637 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008638 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8639 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8640 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8641 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008642
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008643ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8644 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8645 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8646
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008647wait_end
8648 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8649 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8650 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8651 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8652 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8653 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8654 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8655 inspection.
8656
8657 Examples :
8658 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8659 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8660 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8661
8662 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8663 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8664 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8665 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8666 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8667 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8668 tcp-request content reject
8669
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086717.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8672--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008673
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008674A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008675application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8676read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8677than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8678
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008679base <string>
8680 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8681 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8682 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8683 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8684 See also "path" and "uri".
8685
8686base_beg <string>
8687 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8688 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8689 "path_beg".
8690
8691base_dir <string>
8692 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8693 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8694 "path_dir" instead.
8695
8696base_dom <string>
8697 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8698 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8699 instead.
8700
8701base_end <string>
8702 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8703 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8704
8705base_len <integer>
8706 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8707 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8708
8709base_reg <regex>
8710 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8711 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8712 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8713 and all "base_" criteria.
8714
8715base_sub <string>
8716 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8717 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8718 also "base_dir".
8719
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008720cook(<name>) <string>
8721 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8722 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8723 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8724 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8725 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8726 sent by the server.
8727
8728 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8729 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8730 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8731
8732 cook(profile) silver gold
8733
8734cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8735 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8736 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8737 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8738
8739cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8740 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8741 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8742 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8743 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8744 server.
8745
8746cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8747 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8748 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8749 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8750 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8751 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8752
8753cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8754 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8755 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8756 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8757 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8758
8759cook_end(<name>) <string>
8760 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8761 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8762 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8763
8764cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8765 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8766 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8767 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8768 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8769 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8770
8771cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8772 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8773 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8774 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8775 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8776 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8777
8778cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8779 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8780 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8781 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8782
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008783cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8784 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8785 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8786 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8787 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8788 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008790hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008791hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8793 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8794 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8795 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008796 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8797 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8798 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8799 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8800 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801
8802 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008803 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008804 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8805
8806 hdr(Connection) -i close
8807
8808hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008809hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008810 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8811 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8812 response headers sent by the server.
8813
8814hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008815hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008816 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8817 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8818 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8819 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8820 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8821 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8822 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8823
8824hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008825hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008826 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8827 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8828 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8829 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8830 headers sent by the server.
8831
8832hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008833hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008834 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8835 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8836 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8837 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8838 server.
8839
8840hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008841hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8843 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8844 response headers sent by the server.
8845
8846hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008847hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8848 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8849 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8850 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8852
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008853hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008854hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008855 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8856 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8857 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8858 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8859
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008860hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008861hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008862 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8864 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8865 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8866 response headers sent by the server.
8867
8868hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008869hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008870 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8871 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8872 response headers sent by the server.
8873
8874hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008875hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008876 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8877 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8878 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8879 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8880
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008881http_auth(<userlist>)
8882http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008883 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8884 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8885 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8886 of specified groups.
8887
8888 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8889
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008890http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008891 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8892 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8893 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8894 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8895
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008896method <string>
8897 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8898 already check for most common methods.
8899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008900path <string>
8901 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8902 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8903 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8904
8905path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008906 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8907 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008909path_dir <string>
8910 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8911 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8912 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8913 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8914
8915path_dom <string>
8916 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8917 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8918 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008920path_end <string>
8921 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8922 control file name extension.
8923
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008924path_len <integer>
8925 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8926 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8927
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008928path_reg <regex>
8929 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8930 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8931 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8932
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008933path_sub <string>
8934 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8935 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8936 "path_dir".
8937
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008938payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8939 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8940 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8941 strings.
8942
8943payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8944 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8945 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8946 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8947 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8948 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8949
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008950req_ver <string>
8951 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8952 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8953
8954status <integer>
8955 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8956 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8957 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008959url <string>
8960 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008961 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008962
8963url_beg <string>
8964 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008965 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8966 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008967
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008968url_dir <string>
8969 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8970 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8971 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8972 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8973
8974url_dom <string>
8975 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8976 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8977 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8978
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008979url_end <string>
8980 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8981 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008982
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008983url_ip <address>
8984 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8985 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8986 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008987
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008988url_len <integer>
8989 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8990 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8991
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008992url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008993 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8994 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008995 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008996 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008998url_reg <regex>
8999 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
9000 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009001 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009002
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009003url_sub <string>
9004 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
9005 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009006
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009007urlp(<name>) <string>
9008 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
9009 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
9010
9011 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
9012 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
9013
9014urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9015 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9016 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9017 protocol scheme.
9018
9019urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9020 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9021 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9022 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9023 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9024
9025urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9026 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9027 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9028 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9029 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9030
9031urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9032 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9033
9034urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009035 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9036 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009037
9038urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9039 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9040 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9041
9042urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9043 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9044 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9045 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9046 "urlp_" criteria.
9047
9048urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9049 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9050 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9051 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9052
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009053urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9054 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9055 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9056 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9057 negative data.
9058
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090607.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9061---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9064every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009065order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009067ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9068---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009069FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009070HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009071HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9072HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009073HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9074HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9075HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9076HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9077LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9079METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9080METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9081METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9082METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9083METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009084RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009085REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009086TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009087WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9088---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009089
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090917.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9092----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009094Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9095combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009097 - AND (implicit)
9098 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9099 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009101A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009103 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009105Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9106indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009108For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9109"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9110requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9111is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9114 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9115 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9116 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009118To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9119and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009121 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9122 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9123 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9124 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009126 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9127 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9128 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9129 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009130
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009131It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9132expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9133be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009134the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009135
9136 The following rule :
9137
9138 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9139 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9140
9141 Can also be written that way :
9142
9143 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9144
9145It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9146to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9147simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9148sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9149good use is the following :
9150
9151 With named ACLs :
9152
9153 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9154 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9155 monitor fail if site_dead
9156
9157 With anonymous ACLs :
9158
9159 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009161See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009162
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009163
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091647.8. Pattern extraction
9165-----------------------
9166
9167The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9168response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9169for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9170
9171All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9172"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9173begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9174arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9175much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9176equivalent used in ACLs.
9177
9178The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9179
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009180 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9181 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9182 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9183 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9184 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9185 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9186 requested objects by host/path.
9187
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009188 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009189 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9190 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9191 according to RFC 4291.
9192
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009193 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9194 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9195 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009196 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9197 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9198 according to RFC 4291.
9199
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009200 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9201 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9202 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9203 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9204 type integer and only works with such tables.
9205
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009206 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9207 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9208 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9209 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9210 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9211 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9212 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009213 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009214
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009215 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9216 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9217 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9218 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9219 wiser to use "url" instead.
9220
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009221 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009222 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9223 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9224 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9225 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009226
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009227 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009228 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9229 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9230 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9231 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9232 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9233 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9234 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9235 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009236
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009237 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9238 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9239 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9240 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9241
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009242 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9243 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9244
9245 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9246 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9247 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9248
9249 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9250 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9251
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009252 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9253 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9254 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9255 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9256 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9257 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9258 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9259 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9260 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9261 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9262 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9263
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009264 ssl_c_key_alg
9265 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9266 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9267 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9268
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009269 ssl_c_notafter
9270 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9271 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9272 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9273
9274 ssl_c_notbefore
9275 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9276 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9277 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9278
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009279 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9280 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9281 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9282 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9283 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9284 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9285 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9286 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9287 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9288 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9289 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9290
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009291 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9292 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9293 layer.
9294
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009295 ssl_c_sig_alg
9296 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9297 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9298 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9299
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009300 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9301 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9302 error is encountered.
9303
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009304 ssl_c_version
9305 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9306 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9307 layer.
9308
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009309 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9310 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9311 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9312 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9313 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9314 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9315 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9316 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9317 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9318 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9319 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9320
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009321 ssl_f_key_alg
9322 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9323 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9324 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9325
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009326 ssl_f_notafter
9327 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9328 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9329 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9330
9331 ssl_f_notbefore
9332 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9333 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9334 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9335
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009336 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9337 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9338 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9339 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9340 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9341 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9342 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9343 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9344 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9345 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9346 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9347
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009348 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9349 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9350 layer.
9351
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009352 ssl_f_sig_alg
9353 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9354 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9355 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9356
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009357 ssl_f_version
9358 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9359 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9360 layer.
9361
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009362 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9363 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9364 otherwise zero.
9365
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009366 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9367 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9368 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9369
9370 ssl_fc_cipher
9371 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9372 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9373
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009374 ssl_fc_has_crt
9375 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9376 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9377
9378 ssl_fc_has_sni
9379 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009380 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9381 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009382 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009383 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009384
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009385 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009386 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9387 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9388 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9389 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009390 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009391
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009392 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009393 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9394 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009395
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009396 ssl_fc_session_id
9397 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9398 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9399 stick on a given client.
9400
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009401 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009402 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9403 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9404 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9405 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9406 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009407
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009408 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9409 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9410 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9411
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009412 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9413 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9414 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9415 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9416
9417 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9418 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9419 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9420 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9421 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9422 table for a given source address.
9423
9424 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9425 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9426
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009427 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009428 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009429 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9430 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9431 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9432 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9433 where cookies cannot be used.
9434
9435 Example :
9436 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9437 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9438 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9439 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009440
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009441 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009442 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9443 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9444 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9445 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009446
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009447 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9448 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9449 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9450 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9451 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9452 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9453 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009454
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009455 Example :
9456 listen tse-farm
9457 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9458 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9459 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9460 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9461 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9462 persist rdp-cookie
9463 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9464 # This is only useful makes sense if
9465 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9466 stick-table type string size 204800
9467 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9468 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9469 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009470
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009471 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9472 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009473
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009474 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009475 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009476 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9477 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9478 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9479 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9480 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9481 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009482
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009483 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009484
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009485 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009486 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9487 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9488 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9489
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009490 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9491 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9492 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9493 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9494 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009495
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009496 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009497
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009498
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009499The currently available list of transformations include :
9500
9501 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9502 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9503 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9504
9505 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9506 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9507 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9508
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009509 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009510 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9511 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9512 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9513 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095168. Logging
9517----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009518
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009519One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9520provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9521very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9522provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9523state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009524to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009525headers.
9526
9527In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9528about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9529send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9530
9531 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9532 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9533 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9534 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9535 at the termination.
9536
9537The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9538allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9539as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9540while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9541real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9542delay.
9543
9544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095458.1. Log levels
9546---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009547
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009548TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009549source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009550HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9551in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9552track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9553syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9554about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009555
9556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095578.2. Log formats
9558----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009559
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009560HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009561and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9562slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9563options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009564
9565 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9566 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9567 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9568 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9569 extents.
9570
9571 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9572 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9573 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9574 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9575 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9576
9577 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9578 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9579 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9580 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9581 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9582
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009583 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9584 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9585 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9586 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009588 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9589
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009590Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9591specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9592field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9593servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9594always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9595identifier.
9596
9597Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9598 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9599 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9600 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9601 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9602
9603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096048.2.1. Default log format
9605-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009606
9607This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9608as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9609format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9610
9611 Example :
9612 listen www
9613 mode http
9614 log global
9615 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9616
9617 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9618 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9619 (www/HTTP)
9620
9621 Field Format Extract from the example above
9622 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9623 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9624 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9625 4 'to' to
9626 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9627 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9628
9629Detailed fields description :
9630 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9631 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9632 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9633 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9634 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9635 and processed the connection.
9636 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9637
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009638In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9639"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9640connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009642It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9643will eventually disappear.
9644
9645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096468.2.2. TCP log format
9647---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009648
9649The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9650is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9651information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9652counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9653emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9654environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9655the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9656sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009657specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9658not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9659fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9660marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009661
9662 Example :
9663 frontend fnt
9664 mode tcp
9665 option tcplog
9666 log global
9667 default_backend bck
9668
9669 backend bck
9670 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9671
9672 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9673 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9674 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9675
9676 Field Format Extract from the example above
9677 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9678 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9679 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9680 4 frontend_name fnt
9681 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9682 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9683 7 bytes_read* 212
9684 8 termination_state --
9685 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9686 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9687
9688Detailed fields description :
9689 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009690 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9691 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9692 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9693 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9694 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009695
9696 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009697 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9698 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9699 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009700
9701 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9702 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9703 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9704 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9705
9706 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9707 and processed the connection.
9708
9709 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9710 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9711 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9712 applications.
9713
9714 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9715 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9716 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9717 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9718 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9719
9720 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9721 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9722 See "Timers" below for more details.
9723
9724 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9725 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9726 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9727 "Timers" below for more details.
9728
9729 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9730 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9731 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9732 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9733 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9734 details.
9735
9736 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9737 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9738 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9739 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9740 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9741
9742 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9743 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9744 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9745 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9746 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9747 for more details.
9748
9749 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009750 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009751 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9752 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9753 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009754 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009755
9756 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9757 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9758 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9759 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9760 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9761 caused by a denial of service attack.
9762
9763 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9764 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9765 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9766 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9767 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9768 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9769 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9770 denial of service attack.
9771
9772 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9773 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9774 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9775 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9776 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9777 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9778 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9779 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9780 be processed than on other servers.
9781
9782 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9783 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9784 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9785 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9786 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9787 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9788 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9789 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9790 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9791 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9792 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9793 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9794 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9795
9796 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9797 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9798 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9799 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9800 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9801 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9802 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9803 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9804
9805 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9806 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9807 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9808 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9809 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9810 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9811 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9812 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9813 occurs.
9814
9815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098168.2.3. HTTP log format
9817----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009818
9819The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9820is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9821the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9822are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9823emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9824generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9825"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9826which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009827frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9828is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009829
9830Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9831slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9832with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9833
9834 Example :
9835 frontend http-in
9836 mode http
9837 option httplog
9838 log global
9839 default_backend bck
9840
9841 backend static
9842 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9843
9844 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9845 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9846 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009847 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009848
9849 Field Format Extract from the example above
9850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9851 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9852 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9853 4 frontend_name http-in
9854 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9855 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9856 7 status_code 200
9857 8 bytes_read* 2750
9858 9 captured_request_cookie -
9859 10 captured_response_cookie -
9860 11 termination_state ----
9861 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9862 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9863 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9864 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9865 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009867
9868Detailed fields description :
9869 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009870 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9871 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9872 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9873 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9874 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009875
9876 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009877 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9878 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9879 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009880
9881 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9882 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9883 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9884 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9885 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9886
9887 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9888 and processed the connection.
9889
9890 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9891 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9892 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9893
9894 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9895 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9896 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9897 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9898 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9899 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9900
9901 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9902 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9903 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9904 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9905 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9906 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9907
9908 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9909 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9910 See "Timers" below for more details.
9911
9912 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9913 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9914 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9915 below for more details.
9916
9917 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9918 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9919 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9920 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9921 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9922 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9923 for more details.
9924
9925 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9926 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9927 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9928 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9929 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9930 details.
9931
9932 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9933 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9934 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9935
9936 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9937 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9938 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9939 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9940 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9941 overflowing.
9942
9943 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9944 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9945 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9946 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9947 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9948 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9949 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9950 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9951
9952 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9953 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9954 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9955 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9956 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9957 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9958 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9959 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9960
9961 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9962 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9963 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9964 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9965 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9966 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9967 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9968
9969 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009970 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009971 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9972 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9973 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009974 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009975 system.
9976
9977 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9978 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9979 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9980 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9981 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9982 caused by a denial of service attack.
9983
9984 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9985 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9986 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9987 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9988 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9989 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9990 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9991 denial of service attack.
9992
9993 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9994 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9995 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9996 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9997 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9998 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9999 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10000 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
10001 processed than on other servers.
10002
10003 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10004 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10005 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10006 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10007 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10008 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10009 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10010 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10011 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10012 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10013 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10014 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10015 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10016
10017 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10018 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10019 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10020 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10021 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10022 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10023 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10024 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10025
10026 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10027 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10028 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10029 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10030 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10031 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10032 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10033 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10034 occurs.
10035
10036 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10037 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10038 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10039 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10040 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10041 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10042 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10043 cookies" below for more details.
10044
10045 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10046 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10047 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10048 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10049 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10050 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10051 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10052 and cookies" below for more details.
10053
10054 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10055 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10056 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10057 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10058 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10059 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10060 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10061 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10062
10063
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100648.2.4. Custom log format
10065------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010066
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010067The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10068mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010069
10070HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10071Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10072separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10073prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10074
10075Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10076variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10077string formats ("Q").
10078
10079Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10080HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10081
10082Flags are :
10083 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010084 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010085
10086 Example:
10087
10088 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10089 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10090
10091At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10092
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010093 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010094 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010095
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010096the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010097
10098 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010099 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010100 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10101
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010102and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10103
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010104 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010105 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10106
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010107Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10108
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010109 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010110 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010111 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10112 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10113 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10114 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010115 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010116 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010117 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010118 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010119 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10120 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10121 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010122 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010123 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10124 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10125 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010126 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010127 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010128 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10129 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010130 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010131 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10132 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10133 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10134 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10135 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10136 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010137 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10138 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10139 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010140 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010141 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010142 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010143 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10144 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10145 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10146 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010147 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010148 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010149 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010150 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10151 | | %s | server_name | string |
10152 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10153 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010154 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10155 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10156 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010157 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010158 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010159 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010160 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010161
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010162 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101648.3. Advanced logging options
10165-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010166
10167Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10168just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10169options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10170for more information about their usage.
10171
10172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10174------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010175
10176It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10177haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10178commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10179monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10180ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10181
10182 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10183 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10184 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10185 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10186
10187 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10188 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10189 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10190 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10191 such as other load-balancers.
10192
10193 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10194 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10195 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10196
10197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101988.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10199----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010200
10201The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10202what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10203or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10204"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10205just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10206log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10207after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10208is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10209with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10210with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10211
10212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102138.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10214------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010215
10216Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10217for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10218"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10219retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10220raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10221a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10222file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10223you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10224"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10225
10226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102278.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10228--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010229
10230Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10231multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10232them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10233"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10234logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10235error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10236and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10237too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10238useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10239alternative.
10240
10241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102428.4. Timing events
10243------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010244
10245Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10246reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10247the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10248frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10249mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10250
10251 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10252 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10253 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10254 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10255 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10256
10257 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10258 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10259 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10260 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10261 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10262
10263 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10264 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10265 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10266 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10267 connection never established.
10268
10269 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10270 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10271 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10272 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10273 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10274 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10275 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10276 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10277 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10278 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10279 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10280
10281 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10282 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10283 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10284 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10285 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10286
10287 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10288
10289 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10290 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10291 negative.
10292
10293These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10294protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10295that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010296due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010297close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10298session has been aborted on timeout.
10299
10300Most common cases :
10301
10302 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10303 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10304 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10305 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10306 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10307 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10308 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10309 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10310 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010311 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10312 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10313 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010314
10315 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10316 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10317 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10318 of ms on remote networks.
10319
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010320 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10321 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10322 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010323
10324 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10325 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10326 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10327 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10328 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10329 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10330 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10331 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10332 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10333 to the server until another one is released.
10334
10335Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10336
10337 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10338 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10339 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10340
10341 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10342 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10343 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10344
10345 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10346 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10347 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10348 flags.
10349
10350 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10351 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10352 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10353 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10354 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10355 the client connection was maintained open.
10356
10357 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10358 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10359 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10360 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10361
10362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103638.5. Session state at disconnection
10364-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010365
10366TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10367"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10369each of which has a special meaning :
10370
10371 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10372 session to terminate :
10373
10374 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10375
10376 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10377 server explicitly refused it.
10378
10379 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10380 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10381 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10382 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10383 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10384 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10385
10386 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10387 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10388 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10389 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10390 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10391
10392 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10393 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10394 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10395 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10396 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10397
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010398 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10399 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10400
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010401 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10402 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10403 backup connections when going up.
10404
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010405 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10406
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010407 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10408 send or receive data.
10409
10410 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10411 send or receive data.
10412
10413 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10414 with nothing left in the buffers.
10415
10416 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10417
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010418 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010419 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10420
10421 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10422 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10423 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10424 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10425 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10426
10427 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10428 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10429
10430 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10431 server (HTTP only).
10432
10433 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10434
10435 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10436 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10437 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10438
10439 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10440 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10441 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10442
10443 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10444
10445 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10446 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10447
10448 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10449 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10450 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10451
10452 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10453 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010454 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10455 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010456
10457 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10458 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10459 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10460 another server.
10461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010462 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010463 server.
10464
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010465 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10466 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10467 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10468 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10469
10470 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10471 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10472 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10473 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10474
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010475 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10476 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10477 "use-server" rule).
10478
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010479 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10480
10481 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10482 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10483
10484 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10485
10486 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10487 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10488 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10489
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010490 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10491 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10492 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10493 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10494 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10495
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010496 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10497
10498 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10499 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10500
10501 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10502
10503 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10504
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010505The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10506was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010507helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10508starvation, attacks, etc...
10509
10510The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10511alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10512easier finding and understanding.
10513
10514 Flags Reason
10515
10516 -- Normal termination.
10517
10518 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10519 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10520 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10521 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10522
10523 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10524 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10525 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10526 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10527 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10528 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010529
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010530 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10531 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010532 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010533
10534 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10535 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10536 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10537
10538 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10539 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10540 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10541 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10542 the server takes too long to respond.
10543
10544 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10545 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10546 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10547 long a time to respond.
10548
10549 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10550 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10551 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10552 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10553 and the client.
10554
10555 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10556 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10557 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10558 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10559 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10560 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10561
10562 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10563 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010564 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10565 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10566 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10567 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010569 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010570 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10571 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10572 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10573 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10574 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10575
10576 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10577 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10578 503 or 504 here.
10579
10580 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10581 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10582 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10583 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10584 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10585
10586 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10587 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010588 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010589 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10590 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10591
10592 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10593 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10594 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10595 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10596 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10597 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10598 between haproxy and the server.
10599
10600 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10601 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10602 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10603 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10604 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10605 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10606 solution is to fix the application.
10607
10608 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10609 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10610 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10611 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10612 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10613 external attacks.
10614
10615 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10616 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010617 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010618 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10619 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10620
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010621 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10622 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10623 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10624 the client.
10625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010626 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10627 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10628 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10629 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010630 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10631 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10632 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10633 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10634 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010635
10636 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10637 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10638 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10639 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10640
10641 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10642 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10643 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10644 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10645
10646 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10647 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10648 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10649 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010651The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10652persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10653important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10654re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10655
10656 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10657
10658 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10659 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10660 set on a GET request.
10661
10662 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10663 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010664 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010665 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10666
10667 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10668 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10669 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10670
10671 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10672 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10673 already got a cookie.
10674
10675 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10676 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10677 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10678 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10679 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10680
10681 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10682 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10683 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10684
10685 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10686 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10687 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10688
10689 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10690 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10691
10692 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10693 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10694 then advertised in the response.
10695
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106978.6. Non-printable characters
10698-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010699
10700In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10701consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10702converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10703prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10704being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10705escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10706is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10707'}' when logging headers.
10708
10709Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10710issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10711containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10712
10713Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10714the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10715performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10716
10717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107188.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10719---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010720
10721Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10722achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010723section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010724cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10725the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10726the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010727locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010728not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10729user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10730a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10731wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10732
10733 Examples :
10734 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10735 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10736
10737 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10738 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10739
10740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107418.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10742---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010743
10744Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10745proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10746the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10747server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10748
10749Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10750response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010751section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010752
10753It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010754time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10755appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010756are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10757and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10758follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10759request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10760in the logs.
10761
10762 Example :
10763 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10764 listen proxy-out
10765 mode http
10766 option httplog
10767 option logasap
10768 log global
10769 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10770
10771 # log the name of the virtual server
10772 capture request header Host len 20
10773
10774 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10775 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10776
10777 # log the beginning of the referrer
10778 capture request header Referer len 20
10779
10780 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10781 capture response header Server len 20
10782
10783 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10784 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10785
10786 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10787 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10788
10789 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10790 capture response header Via len 20
10791
10792 # log the URL location during a redirection
10793 capture response header Location len 20
10794
10795 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10796 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10797 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10798 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10799 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10800
10801 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10802 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10803 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10804 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010805 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010806
10807 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10808 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10809 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10810 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10811 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010812 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010813
10814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108158.9. Examples of logs
10816---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010817
10818These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10819them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10820reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10821
10822 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10823 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10824 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10825
10826 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10827 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10828
10829 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10830 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10831 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10832
10833 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10834 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10835
10836 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10837 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10838 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10839
10840 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010841 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010842 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10843 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10844
10845 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10846 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10847 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10848
10849 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10850 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010851 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010852 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10853 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10854 to return the 502 and not the server.
10855
10856 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010857 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010858
10859 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10860 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10861 Nothing was sent to any server.
10862
10863 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10864 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10865
10866 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10867 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10868 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10869 send a 408 return code to the client.
10870
10871 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10872 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10873
10874 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10875 5 seconds ("c----").
10876
10877 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10878 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010879 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010880
10881 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010882 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010883 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10884 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10885 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10886 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10887 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010888
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108909. Statistics and monitoring
10891----------------------------
10892
10893It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10894mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10895CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10896Unix socket.
10897
10898
108999.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010900---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010901
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010902The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10903page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010905 0. pxname: proxy name
10906 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10907 for server)
10908 2. qcur: current queued requests
10909 3. qmax: max queued requests
10910 4. scur: current sessions
10911 5. smax: max sessions
10912 6. slim: sessions limit
10913 7. stot: total sessions
10914 8. bin: bytes in
10915 9. bout: bytes out
10916 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010917 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010918 12. ereq: request errors
10919 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010920 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010921 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10922 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010923 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010924 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10925 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10926 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10927 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10928 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10929 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10930 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10931 25. qlimit: queue limit
10932 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10933 27. iid: unique proxy id
10934 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10935 29. throttle: warm up status
10936 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10937 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010938 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010939 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10940 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10941 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010942 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010943 UNK -> unknown
10944 INI -> initializing
10945 SOCKERR -> socket error
10946 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10947 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10948 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10949 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10950 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10951 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10952 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10953 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10954 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10955 disable-on-404
10956 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10957 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10958 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010959 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10960 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010961 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10962 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10963 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10964 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10965 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10966 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010967 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10968 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10969 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10970 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010971 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10972 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010973
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109759.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010976-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010977
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010978The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010979must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10980is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10981a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10982risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10983followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10984given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10985then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10986to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010987
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010988It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10989on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10990own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010991
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010992clear counters
10993 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10994 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10995 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10996 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10997 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10998
10999clear counters all
11000 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
11001 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
11002 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
11003
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011004clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
11005 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
11006
11007 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
11008 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
11009 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
11010 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
11011 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
11012 later after the session ends is usual enough.
11013
11014 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11015
11016 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11017 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11018 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11019 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11020 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11021 the ACLs :
11022
11023 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11024 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11025 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11026 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11027 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11028 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11029
11030 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011031 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11032 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011033
11034 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011035 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011036 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011037 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11038 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11039 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11040 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011041
11042 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11043
11044 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011045 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011046 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11047 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011048 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11049 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11050 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011051
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011052disable frontend <frontend>
11053 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11054 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11055 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11056 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11057 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11058 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11059 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11060 on the stats page.
11061
11062 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11063 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11064
11065 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11066 level "admin".
11067
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011068disable server <backend>/<server>
11069 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11070 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11071 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11072 during the maintenance.
11073
11074 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11075 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11076
11077 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011078 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011079
11080 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11081 level "admin".
11082
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011083enable frontend <frontend>
11084 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11085 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11086 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11087 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11088 which was disabled.
11089
11090 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11091 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11092
11093 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11094 level "admin".
11095
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011096enable server <backend>/<server>
11097 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11098 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11099
11100 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011101 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011102
11103 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11104 level "admin".
11105
11106get weight <backend>/<server>
11107 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11108 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11109 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11110 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11111 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011112 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011113
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011114help
11115 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11116 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011117
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011118prompt
11119 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11120 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11121 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11122 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11123 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11124 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11125 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11126 command.
11127
11128quit
11129 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011130
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011131set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011132 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11133 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11134 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11135 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11136 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011137 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11138 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11139
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011140set maxconn global <maxconn>
11141 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11142 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11143 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11144 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11145 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11146 setting.
11147
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011148set rate-limit connections global <value>
11149 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11150 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11151 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11152 is passed in number of connections per second.
11153
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011154set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11155 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11156 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
11157 passed in number of kilobytes per second.
11158
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011159set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11160 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11161 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11162 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11163 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11164 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11165
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011166set timeout cli <delay>
11167 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11168 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11169 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11170
11171set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11172 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11173 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11174 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11175 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11176 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11177 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11178 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11179 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11180 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11181 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11182 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11183 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11184 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011185 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011186
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011187show errors [<iid>]
11188 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11189 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011190 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11191 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11192 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011193
11194 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11195 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11196 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11197 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11198 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11199 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11200 are reported too.
11201
11202 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11203 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11204 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11205 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11206 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11207 code.
11208
11209 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11210 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11211 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11212 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11213 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11214 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11215 line.
11216
11217 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011218 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11219 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011220 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11221 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11222
11223 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11224 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11225 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11226 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11227 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11228 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11229 00204+ minal\r\n
11230 00211 \r\n
11231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011232 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011233 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11234 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11235 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11236 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11237 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11238 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011239
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011240show info
11241 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11242
11243show sess
11244 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011245 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11246 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11247
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011248show sess <id>
11249 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11250 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11251 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11252 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11253 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11254 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011255
11256show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11257 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11258 possible to dump only selected items :
11259 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11260 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11261 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11262 for example:
11263 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11264 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11265 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11266
11267 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011268 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11269 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011270 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11271 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11272 Nbproc: 1
11273 Process_num: 1
11274 (...)
11275
11276 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11277 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11278 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11279 (...)
11280 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11281
11282 $
11283
11284 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11285 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11286 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11287 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011288 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011289
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011290show table
11291 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11292 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11293 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11294 entries currently in use.
11295
11296 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011297 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011298 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11299 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011300
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011301show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011302 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11303 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11304 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011305 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11306
11307 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11308 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11309 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11310 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11311 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11312
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011313 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11314 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11315 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11316 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11317 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11318 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11319
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011320
11321 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011322 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11323 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011324
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011325 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011326 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011327 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011328 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11329 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11330 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11331 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011332
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011333 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011334 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011335 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11336 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011337
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011338 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11339 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011340 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011341 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11342 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011343
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011344 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11345 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011346 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011347 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11348 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11349
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011350 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11351 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11352 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11353 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11354 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11355
11356 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11357 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11358 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011359 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11360 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011361 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11362 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011363
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011364shutdown frontend <frontend>
11365 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11366 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11367 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11368 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11369 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11370 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11371 once it is terminated.
11372
11373 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11374 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11375
11376 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11377 level "admin".
11378
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011379shutdown session <id>
11380 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11381 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11382 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11383 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11384 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11385 flag in the logs.
11386
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011387shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11388 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11389 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11390 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11391 'K' flag in the logs.
11392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011393/*
11394 * Local variables:
11395 * fill-column: 79
11396 * End:
11397 */